blob: e2a6d3461640a6f8326ff967b7158a05d38bd648 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Fariborz Jahanian8e5fc9b2010-12-21 00:44:01 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not warn about deprecated
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
Fariborz Jahanian8e5fc9b2010-12-21 00:44:01 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
59 bool UnkownObjCClass) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000060 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
61 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
62 // emit them now.
63 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
64 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
65 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
66 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
67 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
68 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
69
70 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
71 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
72 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
73 // diagnostics again.
74 Suppressed.clear();
75 }
76 }
77
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000078 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000079 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
Fariborz Jahanian8e5fc9b2010-12-21 00:44:01 +000080 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc, UnkownObjCClass);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000081
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000082 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000083 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e5fc9b2010-12-21 00:44:01 +000084 if (UA->getMessage().empty()) {
85 if (!UnkownObjCClass)
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
87 else
88 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable_fwdclass_message)
89 << D->getDeclName();
90 }
91 else
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000092 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000093 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000094 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
95 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000096
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000097 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
100 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
101 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
102 return true;
103 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +0000104 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000105
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000106 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
107 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
108 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
109
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000110 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000111}
112
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000113/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000115/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
116///
117void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000118 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000119 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000120 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000121 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000122
123 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
124 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000125 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
126 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000127
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000128 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
129 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000130 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000131 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
132 int isMethod = 0;
133 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
134 // skip over named parameters.
135 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
136 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
137 if (nullPos)
138 --nullPos;
139 else
140 ++i;
141 }
142 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
143 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 // skip over named parameters.
146 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
147 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
148 if (nullPos)
149 --nullPos;
150 else
151 ++i;
152 }
153 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000154 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 // block or function pointer call.
156 QualType Ty = V->getType();
157 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000158 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000159 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
160 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000161 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
162 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
163 unsigned k;
164 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
165 if (nullPos)
166 --nullPos;
167 else
168 ++i;
169 }
170 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
171 }
172 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
173 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000174 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000175 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000176 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000177 return;
178
179 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000180 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000181 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000182 return;
183 }
184 int sentinel = i;
185 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
186 --sentinelPos;
187 ++i;
188 }
189 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
190 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000191 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000192 return;
193 }
194 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
195 ++i;
196 ++sentinel;
197 }
198 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000199 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
200 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
201 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000202
203 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
204 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
205
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000206 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000207 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
208 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
209 return;
210
211 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
212 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
213
214 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
215 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000218SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
219 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
220 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
221}
222
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000223//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
224// Standard Promotions and Conversions
225//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
226
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000227/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
228void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
229 QualType Ty = E->getType();
230 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
231
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000232 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000234 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000235 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
236 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
237 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
238 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
239 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
240 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
241 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000242 //
243 // C++ 4.2p1:
244 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
245 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
246 //
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +0000247 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000248 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000249 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000250 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000251}
252
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000253void Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000254 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
255 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
256 // converted to a prvalue.
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000257 if (!E->isGLValue()) return;
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +0000258
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000259 QualType T = E->getType();
260 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +0000261
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000262 // Create a load out of an ObjCProperty l-value, if necessary.
263 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
264 ConvertPropertyForRValue(E);
265 if (!E->isGLValue())
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +0000266 return;
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000267 }
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +0000268
269 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
270 // expressions of certain types in C++.
271 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
272 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
273 T->isDependentType() ||
274 T->isRecordType()))
275 return;
276
277 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
278 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's
279 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
280 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified
281 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
282 if (T->isVoidType())
283 return;
284
285 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
286 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
287 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
288 // rvalue is T.
289 //
290 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
291 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
292 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
293 // type of the lvalue.
294 if (T.hasQualifiers())
295 T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
296
297 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue,
298 E, 0, VK_RValue);
299}
300
301void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
302 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
303 DefaultLvalueConversion(E);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000304}
305
306
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000307/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000309/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
310/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
311/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000312Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&E) {
313 // First, convert to an r-value.
314 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
315
316 QualType Ty = E->getType();
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000317 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000318
319 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
320 // promotable type.
321 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
322 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
323 //
324 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
325 // unsigned int may be used:
326 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
327 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
328 // and unsigned int.
329 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
330 //
331 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
332 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
333 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
334 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
335
336 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
337 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
338 ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
339 return E;
340 }
341 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
342 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
343 ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
344 return E;
345 }
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000346 }
347
John McCall0ae287a2010-12-01 04:43:34 +0000348 return E;
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000349}
350
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000351/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000352/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000353/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
354void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
355 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
356 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000357
John McCall40c29132010-12-06 18:36:11 +0000358 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
359
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000360 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000361 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
John McCall40c29132010-12-06 18:36:11 +0000362 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast);
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000363}
364
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000365/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
366/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
367/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
368/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000369bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
370 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000371 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000372
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000373 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
374 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
375 // etc.
376 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
377 return false;
378
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000379 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000380 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
381 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
382 << Expr->getType() << CT))
383 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000384
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000385 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000386 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000387 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
388 << Expr->getType() << CT))
389 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000390
391 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000392}
393
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000394/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
395/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000396/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000397/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
398/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
399/// GCC.
400QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
401 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000402 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000403 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000404
405 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000406
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000407 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000408 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000409 QualType lhs =
410 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000411 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000412 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000413
414 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
415 if (lhs == rhs)
416 return lhs;
417
418 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
419 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
420 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
421 return lhs;
422
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000423 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
424 QualType lhs_unpromoted = lhs;
425 if (lhs->isPromotableIntegerType())
426 lhs = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(lhs);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000427 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000428 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
429 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000430 if (lhs != lhs_unpromoted && !isCompAssign)
431 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000432
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000433 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
434 if (lhs == rhs)
435 return lhs;
436
437 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
438
439 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
440 bool LHSComplexFloat = lhs->isComplexType();
441 bool RHSComplexFloat = rhs->isComplexType();
442 if (LHSComplexFloat || RHSComplexFloat) {
443 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
444
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000445 if (!RHSComplexFloat && !rhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
446 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
447 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
448 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
449 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
450 } else {
451 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000452 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000453 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000454 return lhs;
455 }
456
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000457 if (!LHSComplexFloat && !lhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
458 if (!isCompAssign) {
459 // int -> float -> _Complex float
460 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
461 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(rhs)->getElementType();
462 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
463 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
464 } else {
465 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000466 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000467 }
468 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000469 return rhs;
470 }
471
472 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
473 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
474 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
475 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
476 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
477 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
478 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
479 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
480 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
481 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
482 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
483
484 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type.
485 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat) {
486 if (order > 0) {
487 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000488 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000489 return lhs;
490
491 } else if (order < 0) {
492 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
493 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000494 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000495 return rhs;
496 }
497 return lhs;
498 }
499
500 // If just the LHS is complex, the RHS needs to be converted,
501 // and the LHS might need to be promoted.
502 if (LHSComplexFloat) {
503 if (order > 0) { // LHS is wider
504 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000505 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
506 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_FloatingCast);
507 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000508 return lhs;
509 }
510
511 // RHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
512 QualType result = (order == 0 ? lhs : Context.getComplexType(rhs));
513
514 // double -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000515 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000516
517 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
518 if (!isCompAssign && order < 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000519 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000520
521 return result;
522 }
523
524 // Just the RHS is complex, so the LHS needs to be converted
525 // and the RHS might need to be promoted.
526 assert(RHSComplexFloat);
527
528 if (order < 0) { // RHS is wider
529 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000530 if (!isCompAssign) {
531 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
532 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
533 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000534 return rhs;
535 }
536
537 // LHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
538 QualType result = (order == 0 ? rhs : Context.getComplexType(lhs));
539
540 // double -> _Complex double
541 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000542 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000543
544 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
545 if (order > 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000546 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000547
548 return result;
549 }
550
551 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
552 bool LHSFloat = lhs->isRealFloatingType();
553 bool RHSFloat = rhs->isRealFloatingType();
554 if (LHSFloat || RHSFloat) {
555 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
556 // to the bigger result.
557 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
558 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
559 if (order > 0) {
560 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingCast);
561 return lhs;
562 }
563
564 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
565 if (!isCompAssign)
566 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
567 return rhs;
568 }
569
570 // If we have an integer operand, the result is the real floating type.
571 if (LHSFloat) {
572 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
573 // Convert rhs to the lhs floating point type.
574 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
575 return lhs;
576 }
577
578 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
579 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
580 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(lhs);
581
582 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000583 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000584
585 // float -> _Complex float
586 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000587 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000588
589 return result;
590 }
591
592 assert(RHSFloat);
593 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
594 // Convert lhs to the rhs floating point type.
595 if (!isCompAssign)
596 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
597 return rhs;
598 }
599
600 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
601 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
602 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(rhs);
603
604 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
605 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000606 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000607
608 // float -> _Complex float
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000609 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000610
611 return result;
612 }
613
614 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
615 // FIXME: if the operands are (int, _Complex long), we currently
616 // don't promote the complex. Also, signedness?
617 const ComplexType *lhsComplexInt = lhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
618 const ComplexType *rhsComplexInt = rhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
619 if (lhsComplexInt && rhsComplexInt) {
620 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhsComplexInt->getElementType(),
621 rhsComplexInt->getElementType());
622 assert(order && "inequal types with equal element ordering");
623 if (order > 0) {
624 // _Complex int -> _Complex long
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000625 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000626 return lhs;
627 }
628
629 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000630 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000631 return rhs;
632 } else if (lhsComplexInt) {
633 // int -> _Complex int
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000634 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000635 return lhs;
636 } else if (rhsComplexInt) {
637 // int -> _Complex int
638 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000639 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000640 return rhs;
641 }
642
643 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
644 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
645 int compare = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
646 bool lhsSigned = lhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
647 rhsSigned = rhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
648 if (lhsSigned == rhsSigned) {
649 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
650 if (compare >= 0) {
651 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
652 return lhs;
653 } else if (!isCompAssign)
654 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
655 return rhs;
656 } else if (compare != (lhsSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
657 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
658 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
659 if (rhsSigned) {
660 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
661 return lhs;
662 } else if (!isCompAssign)
663 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
664 return rhs;
665 } else if (Context.getIntWidth(lhs) != Context.getIntWidth(rhs)) {
666 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
667 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
668 // use the signed type.
669 if (lhsSigned) {
670 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
671 return lhs;
672 } else if (!isCompAssign)
673 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
674 return rhs;
675 } else {
676 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
677 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
678 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
679 // to the signed type.
680 QualType result =
681 Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhsSigned ? lhs : rhs);
682 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
683 if (!isCompAssign)
684 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
685 return result;
686 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000687}
688
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000689//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
690// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
691//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
692
693
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000694/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000695/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
696/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
697/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
698/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000699///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000700ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000701Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000702 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
703
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000704 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000705 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000706 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000707
708 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
709 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
710 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000711
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000712 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000713 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000714 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000715
716 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000717 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000718 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000719
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000720 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
721 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
722 // strings.
723 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000724 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000725 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000726
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000727 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000728 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
729 Literal.GetStringLength(),
730 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
731 &StringTokLocs[0],
732 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000733}
734
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000735/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
736/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
737/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
738/// for values inside the block or for globals).
739///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000740/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000741/// up-to-date.
742///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000743static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000744 ValueDecl *VD) {
745 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
746 // we wanted to.
747 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
748 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000749
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000750 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
751 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
752 return false;
753
754 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
755 // snapshot it.
756 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
757 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000758 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
759 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000760
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000761 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
762 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
763
764 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
765 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
766 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
767 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000768 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
769 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000770
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000771 if (!NextBlock)
772 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000773
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000774 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
775 // having a reference outside it.
776 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
777 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000778
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000779 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
780 // a snapshot as well.
781 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
782 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000783
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000784 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000785}
786
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000787
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000788ExprResult
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +0000789Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
790 SourceLocation Loc, const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000791 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +0000792 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000793}
794
795/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000796ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000797Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +0000798 ExprValueKind VK,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000799 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
800 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000801 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000802 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000803 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000804 << D->getDeclName();
805 return ExprError();
806 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000807
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000808 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000809 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
810 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
811 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000812 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000813 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000814 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
815 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000816 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
817 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000818 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000819 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000820 << D->getIdentifier();
821 return ExprError();
822 }
823 }
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +0000824
825 // This ridiculousness brought to you by 'extern void x;' and the
826 // GNU compiler collection.
827 } else if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
828 Ty->isVoidType()) {
829 VK = VK_RValue;
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000830 }
831 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000832
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000833 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000834
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +0000835 Expr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000836 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +0000837 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
838 D, NameInfo, Ty, VK);
839
840 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
841 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D) && cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getBitWidth())
842 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
843
844 return Owned(E);
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000845}
846
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000847static ExprResult
848BuildFieldReferenceExpr(Sema &S, Expr *BaseExpr, bool IsArrow,
849 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, FieldDecl *Field,
850 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
851 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo);
852
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000853ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000854Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000855 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000856 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
857 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000858 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
859 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
860 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
861 // found via name lookup.
862 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000863 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000864 VarDecl *BaseObject = IndirectField->getVarDecl();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000865 if (BaseObject) {
866 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
867 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000868 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +0000869 BaseObjectExpr =
870 new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject, BaseObject->getType(),
871 VK_LValue, Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000872 BaseQuals
873 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000874 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
875 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
876 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
877 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
878 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000879 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000880 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
881 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
882 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000883 BaseQuals
884 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000885 } else {
886 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
887 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
888 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000889 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
890 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000891 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000892 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000893 = Context.getTagDeclType(
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000894 cast<RecordDecl>(
895 (*IndirectField->chain_begin())->getDeclContext()));
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000896 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000897 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000898 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
899 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
900 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000901 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000902 MD->getThisType(Context),
903 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000904 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
905 }
906 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000907 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000908 << IndirectField->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000909 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000910 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000911 }
912
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000913 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000914 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000915 << IndirectField->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000916 }
917
918 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
919 // anonymous struct/union.
920 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000921
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000922 IndirectFieldDecl::chain_iterator FI = IndirectField->chain_begin(),
923 FEnd = IndirectField->chain_end();
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000924
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +0000925 // Skip the first VarDecl if present.
926 if (BaseObject)
927 FI++;
928 for (; FI != FEnd; FI++) {
929 FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(*FI);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000930
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000931 // FIXME: the first access can be qualified
932 CXXScopeSpec SS;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000933
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000934 // FIXME: these are somewhat meaningless
935 DeclarationNameInfo MemberNameInfo(Field->getDeclName(), Loc);
936 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(Field, Field->getAccess());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000937
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000938 Result = BuildFieldReferenceExpr(*this, Result, BaseObjectIsPointer,
939 SS, Field, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo)
940 .take();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000941
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +0000942 // All the implicit accesses are dot-accesses.
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000943 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000944 }
945
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000946 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000947}
948
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000949/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000950/// possibly a list of template arguments.
951///
952/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
953/// DecomposeTemplateName.
954///
955/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
956/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
957/// some way.
958static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
959 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
960 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000961 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000962 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
963 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
964 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
965 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
966
967 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
968 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
969 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
970 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
971 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
972
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000973 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000974 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
975 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000976 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
977 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000978 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000979 TemplateArgs = 0;
980 }
981}
982
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000983/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
984/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
985/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000986static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000987 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
988 return false;
989
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000990 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
991 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
992 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
993 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
994 if (!BaseRT) return false;
995
996 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000997 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000998 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
999 return false;
1000 }
1001
1002 return true;
1003}
1004
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001005/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
1006/// the prospective base classes.
1007static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
1008 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
1009 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +00001010 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001011 return false;
1012
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +00001013 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +00001014 if (!RD) return false;
1015 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
1016
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001017 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
1018 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
1019 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
1020 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
1021 if (!BaseRT) return false;
1022
1023 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001024 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
1025 return false;
1026 }
1027
1028 return true;
1029}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001030
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001031enum IMAKind {
1032 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
1033 IMA_Static,
1034
1035 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
1036 IMA_Mixed,
1037
1038 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1039 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
1040 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
1041
1042 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1043 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
1044 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
1045
1046 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
1047 IMA_Instance,
1048
1049 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
1050 IMA_Unresolved,
1051
1052 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
1053 /// context is not an instance method.
1054 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
1055
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001056 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
1057 /// context is not an instance method.
1058 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
1059
1060 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
1061 /// class.
1062 IMA_Error_Unrelated
1063};
1064
1065/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
1066/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
1067/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
1068/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
1069/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
1070/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
1071static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
1072 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001073 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001074
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001075 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001076 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001077 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
1078 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001079
1080 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1081 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
1082
1083 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
1084 bool hasNonInstance = false;
Sebastian Redlf9780002010-11-26 16:28:07 +00001085 bool hasField = false;
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001086 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
1087 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001088 NamedDecl *D = *I;
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00001089
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001090 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
Sebastian Redlf9780002010-11-26 16:28:07 +00001091 if (dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D))
1092 hasField = true;
1093
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001094 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001095 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
1096 }
1097 else
1098 hasNonInstance = true;
1099 }
1100
1101 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
1102 // member reference.
1103 if (Classes.empty())
1104 return IMA_Static;
1105
1106 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
1107 // an implicit member reference.
Sebastian Redlf9780002010-11-26 16:28:07 +00001108 if (isStaticContext) {
1109 if (hasNonInstance)
1110 return IMA_Mixed_StaticContext;
1111
1112 if (SemaRef.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x && hasField) {
1113 // C++0x [expr.prim.general]p10:
1114 // An id-expression that denotes a non-static data member or non-static
1115 // member function of a class can only be used:
1116 // (...)
1117 // - if that id-expression denotes a non-static data member and it appears in an unevaluated operand.
1118 const Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& record = SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back();
1119 bool isUnevaluatedExpression = record.Context == Sema::Unevaluated;
1120 if (isUnevaluatedExpression)
1121 return IMA_Mixed_StaticContext;
1122 }
1123
1124 return IMA_Error_StaticContext;
1125 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001126
1127 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
1128 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
1129 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
1130 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001131 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001132 Classes))
1133 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
1134
1135 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
1136}
1137
1138/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
1139static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
1140 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1141 const LookupResult &R) {
1142 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1143 SourceRange Range(Loc);
1144 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
1145
1146 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
1147 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
1148 if (MD->isStatic()) {
1149 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
1150 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
1151 << Range << R.getLookupName();
1152 return;
1153 }
1154 }
1155
1156 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
1157 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
1158 return;
1159 }
1160
1161 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001162}
1163
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001164/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1165///
1166/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001167bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1168 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001169 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1170
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001171 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001172 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001173 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1174 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001175 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001176 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001177 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1178 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001179
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001180 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1181 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1182 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1183 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001184 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001185 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001186 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1187 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1188
1189 if (!R.empty()) {
1190 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1191 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1192
1193 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1194 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1195 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1196 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
1197
1198 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1199 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1200 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001201 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001202 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1203 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001204 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001205 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001206 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001207 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1208 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1209 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1210 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1211 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1212 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1213 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1214 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1215 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1216 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1217 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1218 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
1219 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
1220 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001221 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001222 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
1223 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
1224 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001225 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001226 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001227 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001228 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001229
1230 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1231 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1232 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1233
1234 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1235 return false;
1236 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +00001237
1238 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001239 }
1240 }
1241
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001242 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001243 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +00001244 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001245 if (!R.empty()) {
1246 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1247 if (SS.isEmpty())
1248 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
1249 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1250 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1251 else
1252 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1253 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1254 << SS.getRange()
1255 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1256 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1257 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
1258 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1259 << ND->getDeclName();
1260
1261 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1262 return false;
1263 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001264
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001265 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1266 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1267 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1268 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1269 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1270 // to recover well anyway.
1271 if (SS.isEmpty())
1272 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1273 else
1274 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1275 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1276 << SS.getRange();
1277
1278 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1279 return true;
1280 }
1281 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001282 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001283 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001284 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001285 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001286 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001287 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001288 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1289 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001290 return true;
1291 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001292 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001293 }
1294
1295 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1296 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1297 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1298 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1299 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1300 << SS.getRange();
1301 return true;
1302 }
1303
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001304 // Give up, we can't recover.
1305 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1306 return true;
1307}
1308
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001309ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1310 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1312 if (!IDecl)
1313 return 0;
1314 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1315 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1316 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001317 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001318 if (!property)
1319 return 0;
1320 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001321 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1322 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001323 return 0;
1324 return property;
1325}
1326
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001327bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1328 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1329 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1330 if (!IDecl)
1331 return false;
1332 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1333 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1334 return false;
1335 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1336 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1337 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1338 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1339 return false;
1340
1341 return true;
1342}
1343
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001344static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001345 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001346 IdentifierInfo *II,
1347 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1348 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001349 bool LookForIvars;
1350 if (Lookup.empty())
1351 LookForIvars = true;
1352 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1353 LookForIvars = false;
1354 else
1355 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1356 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1357 if (!LookForIvars)
1358 return 0;
1359
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001360 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1361 if (!IDecl)
1362 return 0;
1363 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001364 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1365 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001366 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1367 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1368 if (!property)
1369 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001370 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001371 DynamicImplSeen =
1372 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001373 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1374 // one.
1375 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1376 return 0;
1377 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001378 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001379 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1380 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001381 NameLoc,
1382 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
Fariborz Jahanian75049662010-12-15 23:29:04 +00001383 ObjCIvarDecl::Private,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001384 (Expr *)0, true);
1385 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1386 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1387 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1388 return Ivar;
1389 }
1390 return 0;
1391}
1392
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001393ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001394 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1395 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1396 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1397 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001398 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1399 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1400
1401 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001402 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001403
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001404 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001405
1406 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001407 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001409 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001410
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001411 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001412 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001413 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001414
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001415 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1416 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001417 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1418 // (note: handled after lookup)
1419 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1420 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1421 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001422 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1423 // names a dependent type.
1424 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1425 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001426 bool DependentID = false;
1427 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1428 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1429 DependentID = true;
1430 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1431 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1432 if (DC) {
1433 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1434 return ExprError();
1435 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1436 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1437 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1438 } else {
1439 DependentID = true;
1440 }
1441 }
1442
1443 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001444 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001445 TemplateArgs);
1446 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001447 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001448 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001449 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001450 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001451 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1452 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1453 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1454 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1455 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001456 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1457 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1458 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001459 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001460 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001461 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001462
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1464 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001465 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001466 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001467 if (E.isInvalid())
1468 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001469
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001470 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1471 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001472 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1473 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahaniande267602010-11-17 19:41:23 +00001474 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc)) {
1475 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1476 canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II)) {
1477 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_synthesized_ivar_access) << II;
1478 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1479 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001480 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1481 isAddressOfOperand);
Fariborz Jahaniande267602010-11-17 19:41:23 +00001482 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001483 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001484 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1485 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001486 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001487 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001488
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001489 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1490 return ExprError();
1491
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001492 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1493 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001494 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001495
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001496 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001497 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001498 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1499 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1500 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1501 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1502 }
1503
1504 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1505 // call, diagnose the problem.
1506 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001507 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001508 return ExprError();
1509
1510 assert(!R.empty() &&
1511 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001512
1513 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1514 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001515 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001516 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1517 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001518 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001519 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1520 return move(E);
1521 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001522 }
1523 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001524
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001525 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1526 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1527
1528 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001529 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001530 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1531 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001532 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001533 if (Property) {
1534 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1535 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001536 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001537 }
1538 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001539 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001540 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1541 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1542 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1543 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1544 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1545 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001546 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001547 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001548
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001549 QualType T = Func->getType();
1550 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001551 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001552 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1553 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00001554 // Note that functions are r-values in C.
1555 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, VK_RValue, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001556 }
1557 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001558
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001559 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001560 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1561 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1562 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1563 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1564 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1565 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1566 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1567 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001568 //
1569 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1570 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1571 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1572 // non-static member function:
1573 //
1574 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1575 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1576 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1577 // member function call.
1578 //
1579 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1580 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1581 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1582 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001583 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001584 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1585 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1586 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1587 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1588 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1589 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1590 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001591 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1592 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001593 else
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00001594 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
1595 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001596
1597 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001598 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001599 }
1600
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001601 if (TemplateArgs)
1602 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001603
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001604 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1605}
1606
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001607/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001608ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001609Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1610 LookupResult &R,
1611 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1612 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1613 case IMA_Instance:
1614 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1615
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001616 case IMA_Mixed:
1617 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1618 case IMA_Unresolved:
1619 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1620
1621 case IMA_Static:
1622 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1623 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1624 if (TemplateArgs)
1625 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1626 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1627
1628 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1629 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1630 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1631 return ExprError();
1632 }
1633
1634 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1635 return ExprError();
1636}
1637
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001638/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1639/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1640/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1641/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001642ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001643Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001644 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001645 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001646 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001647 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001649 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001650 return ExprError();
1651
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001652 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001653 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1654
1655 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1656 return ExprError();
1657
1658 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001659 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1660 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001661 return ExprError();
1662 }
1663
1664 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1665}
1666
1667/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1668/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1669/// additional lookup.
1670///
1671/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1672/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1673///
1674/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001675ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001676Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001677 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001678 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001679 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001680
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001681 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1682 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1683 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1684 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1685 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1686
1687 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1688 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1689 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001690 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001691
1692 bool LookForIvars;
1693 if (Lookup.empty())
1694 LookForIvars = true;
1695 else if (IsClassMethod)
1696 LookForIvars = false;
1697 else
1698 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1699 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001700 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001701 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001702 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001703 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1704 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1705 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1706 if (IsClassMethod)
1707 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1708 << IV->getDeclName());
1709
1710 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1711 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1712 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1713 return ExprError();
1714
1715 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1716 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1717 return ExprError();
1718
1719 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1720 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1721 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1722 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1723
1724 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1725 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1726 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1727 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001728 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001729 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001730 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001731 SelfName, false, false);
1732 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1733 return ExprError();
1734
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +00001735 Expr *SelfE = SelfExpr.take();
1736 DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfE);
1737
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001738 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1739 return Owned(new (Context)
1740 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +00001741 SelfE, true, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001742 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001743 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001744 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001745 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001746 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1747 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1748 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1749 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1750 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1751 }
1752 }
1753
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001754 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1755 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1756 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1757 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1758 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1759 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1760 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1761 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1762 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1763 }
1764 }
1765 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001766 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1767 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001768}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001769
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001770/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1771///
1772/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1773///
1774/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1775/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1776/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1777/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1778///
1779/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1780/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1781/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1782/// the class declaring the member.
1783///
1784/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1785/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1786/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001787bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001788Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1789 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001790 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001791 NamedDecl *Member) {
1792 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1793 if (!RD)
1794 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001795
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001796 QualType DestRecordType;
1797 QualType DestType;
1798 QualType FromRecordType;
1799 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1800 bool PointerConversions = false;
1801 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1802 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001803
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001804 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1805 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1806 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1807 PointerConversions = true;
1808 } else {
1809 DestType = DestRecordType;
1810 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001811 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001812 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1813 if (Method->isStatic())
1814 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001815
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001816 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1817 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001818
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001819 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1820 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1821 PointerConversions = true;
1822 } else {
1823 FromRecordType = FromType;
1824 DestType = DestRecordType;
1825 }
1826 } else {
1827 // No conversion necessary.
1828 return false;
1829 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001830
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001831 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1832 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001833
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001834 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1835 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1836 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001837
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001838 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1839 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1840
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001841 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001842
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001843 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001844 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001845 // class name.
1846 //
1847 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1848 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1849 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1850 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1851 //
1852 // class Base { public: int x; };
1853 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1854 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1855 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1856 //
1857 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1858 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1859 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1860 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001861 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001862 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1863 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1864 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1865
1866 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1867
1868 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1869 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1870 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1871 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001872 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001873 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001874 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001875 return true;
1876
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001877 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001878 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001879 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1880 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001881
1882 FromType = QType;
1883 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1884
1885 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1886 // we're done.
1887 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1888 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001889 }
1890 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001891
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001892 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001893
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001894 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1895 // down to the using declaration's type.
1896 //
1897 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1898 // class ever has member declarations.
1899 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1900 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1901 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1902 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1903
1904 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1905 // conversion is non-trivial.
1906 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1907 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001908 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001909 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001910 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001911 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001912
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001913 QualType UType = URecordType;
1914 if (PointerConversions)
1915 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001916 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001917 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001918 FromType = UType;
1919 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1920 }
1921
1922 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1923 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1924 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001925 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001926
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001927 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001928 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1929 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001930 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001931 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001932
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001933 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001934 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001935 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001936}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001937
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001938/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001939static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001940 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001941 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001942 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1943 QualType Ty,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00001944 ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001945 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1946 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1947 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001948 if (SS.isSet()) {
1949 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1950 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001951 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001952
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001953 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001954 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00001955 TemplateArgs, Ty, VK, OK);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001956}
1957
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +00001958static ExprResult
1959BuildFieldReferenceExpr(Sema &S, Expr *BaseExpr, bool IsArrow,
1960 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, FieldDecl *Field,
1961 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1962 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo) {
1963 // x.a is an l-value if 'a' has a reference type. Otherwise:
1964 // x.a is an l-value/x-value/pr-value if the base is (and note
1965 // that *x is always an l-value), except that if the base isn't
1966 // an ordinary object then we must have an rvalue.
1967 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
1968 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
1969 if (!IsArrow) {
1970 if (BaseExpr->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
1971 VK = BaseExpr->getValueKind();
1972 else
1973 VK = VK_RValue;
1974 }
1975 if (VK != VK_RValue && Field->isBitField())
1976 OK = OK_BitField;
1977
1978 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
1979 QualType MemberType = Field->getType();
1980 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1981 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
1982 VK = VK_LValue;
1983 } else {
1984 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
1985 if (IsArrow) BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1986
1987 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
1988
1989 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
1990 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
1991
1992 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
1993 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
1994 if (Field->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
1995
1996 Qualifiers MemberQuals
1997 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
1998
1999 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
2000 assert(!MemberQuals.hasAddressSpace());
2001
2002 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2003 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2004 MemberType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2005 }
2006
2007 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberNameInfo.getLoc(), Field);
2008 if (S.PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, SS.getScopeRep(),
2009 FoundDecl, Field))
2010 return ExprError();
2011 return S.Owned(BuildMemberExpr(S.Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
2012 Field, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2013 MemberType, VK, OK));
2014}
2015
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002016/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
2017/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
2018/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
2019/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002020ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002021Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2022 LookupResult &R,
2023 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2024 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002025 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
2026
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002027 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00002028
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00002029 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2030 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00002031 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002032 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00002033 if (IndirectFieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())
2034 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
2035
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002036
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002037 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
2038 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00002039 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
2040 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002041 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
2042 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002043 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2044 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2045 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2046 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00002047 }
2048
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002049 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002050 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
2051 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002052 SS,
2053 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
2054 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002055}
2056
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002057bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002058 const LookupResult &R,
2059 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002060 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
2061 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
2062 return false;
2063
2064 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002065 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002066 return false;
2067
2068 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002069 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002070 return false;
2071
2072 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
2073 // normal lookup:
2074 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
2075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2076
2077 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2078 // -- a declaration of a class member
2079 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
2080 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00002081 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002082 return false;
2083
2084 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2085 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2086 // using-declaration
2087 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2088 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2089 // turn off ADL anyway).
2090 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2091 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2092 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2093 return false;
2094
2095 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2096 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2097 // template
2098 // And also for builtin functions.
2099 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2100 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2101
2102 // But also builtin functions.
2103 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2104 return false;
2105 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2106 return false;
2107 }
2108
2109 return true;
2110}
2111
2112
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002113/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2114/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2115/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2116/// will in fact be used.
2117static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2118 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
2119 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2120 return true;
2121 }
2122
2123 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2124 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2125 return true;
2126 }
2127
2128 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2129 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2130 return true;
2131 }
2132
2133 return false;
2134}
2135
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002136ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002137Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002138 LookupResult &R,
2139 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00002140 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2141 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00002142 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002143 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2144 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002145
2146 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2147 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2148 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002149 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2150 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002151 return ExprError();
2152
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002153 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2154 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2155 // we've picked a target.
2156 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2157
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002158 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00002159 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002160 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002161 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002162 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2163 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002164
2165 return Owned(ULE);
2166}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002167
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002168static ExprValueKind getValueKindForDecl(ASTContext &Context,
2169 const ValueDecl *D) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002170 // FIXME: It's not clear to me why NonTypeTemplateParmDecl is a VarDecl.
2171 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D)) return VK_LValue;
2172 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) return VK_LValue;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002173 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) return VK_RValue;
2174 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2175 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D) && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->isInstance())
2176 return VK_RValue;
2177 return VK_LValue;
2178 }
2179 return Expr::getValueKindForType(D->getType());
2180}
2181
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002182
2183/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002184ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002185Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002186 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2187 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002188 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00002189 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2190 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002191
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002192 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002193 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2194 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002195
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002196 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2197 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2198 // a template argument list.
2199 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
2200 << Template << SS.getRange();
2201 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2202 return ExprError();
2203 }
2204
2205 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2206 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2207 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002208 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002209 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00002210 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002211 return ExprError();
2212 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002213
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002214 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2215 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2216 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2217 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002218 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002219 return ExprError();
2220
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002221 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2222 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002223 return ExprError();
2224
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00002225 // Handle anonymous.
2226 if (IndirectFieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
2227 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
2228
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002229 ExprValueKind VK = getValueKindForDecl(Context, VD);
2230
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002231 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
2232 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
2233 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
2234 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002235 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002236 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
2237 // as they do not get snapshotted.
2238 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002239 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00002240 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00002241 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2242 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
2243 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2244 return ExprError();
2245 }
2246
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00002247 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00002248 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
2249 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2250 return ExprError();
2251 }
2252
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00002253 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002254 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002255
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002256 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002257 bool byrefVar = (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>() != 0);
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00002258 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002259 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE;
2260
2261 if (!byrefVar) {
2262 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
2263 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
2264 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
2265 ExprTy.addConst();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002266 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, VK,
2267 Loc, false, constAdded);
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002268 }
2269 else
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002270 BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, VK, Loc, true);
Fariborz Jahaniane2204552010-11-16 19:29:39 +00002271
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002272 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2273 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
2274 Expr *E = new (Context)
2275 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002276 VK, SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002277 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
2278 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
2279 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002280 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00002281 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002282 SourceLocation(),
2283 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002284 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Douglas Gregor53c374f2010-12-07 00:41:46 +00002285 Res = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Res);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002286 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
2287 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
2288 }
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002289 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00002290 }
2291 }
2292 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002293 }
2294 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
2295 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002296
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002297 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), VK,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002298 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002299}
2300
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002301ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002302 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002303 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002304
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002305 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002306 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002307 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
2308 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
2309 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002310 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002311
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00002312 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
2313 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002315 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00002316 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
2317 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002318 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002319 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002320 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002321 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002322
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002323 QualType ResTy;
2324 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
2325 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2326 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00002327 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002328
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002329 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002330 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002331 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
2332 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002333 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002334}
2335
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002336ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002337 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002338 bool Invalid = false;
2339 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
2340 if (Invalid)
2341 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002342
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00002343 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
2344 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002345 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002346 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002347
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002348 QualType Ty;
2349 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
2350 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
2351 else if (Literal.isWide())
2352 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00002353 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
2354 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002355 else
2356 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002357
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002358 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
2359 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002360 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002361}
2362
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002363ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002364 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002365 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2366 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002367 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002368 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002369 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002370 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002371 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002372
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002373 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002374 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2375 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002376 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002377
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002378 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002379 bool Invalid = false;
2380 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2381 if (Invalid)
2382 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002383
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002384 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002385 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2386 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002387 return ExprError();
2388
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002389 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002390
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002391 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002392 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002393 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002394 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002395 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002396 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002397 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002398 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002399
2400 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2401
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002402 using llvm::APFloat;
2403 APFloat Val(Format);
2404
2405 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002406
2407 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2408 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2409 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2410 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002411 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002412 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002413 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002414 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002415 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2416 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002417 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002418 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2419 }
2420
2421 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2422 << Ty
2423 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2424 }
2425
2426 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002427 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002428
Peter Collingbourne09821362010-12-04 01:50:56 +00002429 if (getLangOptions().SinglePrecisionConstants && Ty == Context.DoubleTy)
2430 ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
2431
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002432 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002433 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002434 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002435 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002436
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002437 // long long is a C99 feature.
2438 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002439 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002440 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2441
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002442 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002443 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002444
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002445 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2446 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2447 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002448 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2449 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002450 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002451 } else {
2452 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2453 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002454
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002455 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2456 // be an unsigned int.
2457 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2458
2459 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002460 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002461 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2462 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002463 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002464
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002465 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2466 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2467 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2468 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002469 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002470 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002471 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002472 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002473 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002474 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002475
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002476 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002477 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002478 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002479
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002480 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2481 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2482 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2483 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002484 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002485 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002486 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002487 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002488 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002489 }
2490
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002491 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002492 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002493 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002494
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002495 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2496 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2497 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2498 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002499 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002500 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002501 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002502 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002503 }
2504 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002505
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002506 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2507 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002508 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002509 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002510 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002511 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002512 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002513
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002514 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
Jay Foad9f71a8f2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002515 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002516 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002517 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002518 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002519
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002520 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2521 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002522 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002523 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002524
2525 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002526}
2527
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002528ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002529 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002530 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002531 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002532}
2533
2534/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2535/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002536bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002537 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002538 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002539 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002540 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2541 return false;
2542
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002543 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2544 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2545 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2546 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2547 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2548 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2549
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002550 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002551 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002552 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002553 if (isSizeof)
2554 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2555 return false;
2556 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002557
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002558 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002559 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002560 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2561 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002562 return false;
2563 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002564
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002565 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002566 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2567 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002568 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002569
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002570 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002571 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002572 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002573 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2574 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002575 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002576
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002577 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002578}
2579
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002580static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2581 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002582 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002583
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002584 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002585 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2586 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002587
2588 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2589 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2590 return false;
2591
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002592 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002593 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002594 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002595 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002596
2597 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2598 // bit-field.
2599 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002600 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002601 return false;
2602
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002603 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002604}
2605
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002606/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002607ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002608Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002609 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002610 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002611 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002612 return ExprError();
2613
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002614 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002615
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002616 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2617 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2618 return ExprError();
2619
2620 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002621 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002622 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2623 R.getEnd()));
2624}
2625
2626/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2627/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002628ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002629Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002630 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2631 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2632 bool isInvalid = false;
2633 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2634 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2635 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002636 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002637 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002638 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2639 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002640 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2641 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2642 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2643 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002644 } else {
2645 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2646 }
2647
2648 if (isInvalid)
2649 return ExprError();
2650
2651 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2652 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2653 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2654 R.getEnd()));
2655}
2656
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002657/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2658/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2659/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002660ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002661Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2662 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002663 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002664 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002665
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002666 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002667 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002668 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002669 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002670 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002671
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002672 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002673 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002674 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2675
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002676 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002677}
2678
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002679static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc,
2680 bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002681 if (V->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002682 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002683
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00002684 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
2685 if (V->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary)
John McCall409fa9a2010-12-06 20:48:59 +00002686 S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V);
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00002687
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002688 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002689 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002690 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002691
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002692 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2693 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2694 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002695
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002696 // Test for placeholders.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002697 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002698 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2699 if (PR.take() != V) {
2700 V = PR.take();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002701 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, isReal);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002702 }
2703
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002704 // Reject anything else.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002705 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002706 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002707 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002708}
2709
2710
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002711
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002712ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002713Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002714 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002715 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002716 switch (Kind) {
2717 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002718 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2719 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002720 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002721
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002722 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002723}
2724
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002725/// Expressions of certain arbitrary types are forbidden by C from
2726/// having l-value type. These are:
2727/// - 'void', but not qualified void
2728/// - function types
2729///
2730/// The exact rule here is C99 6.3.2.1:
2731/// An lvalue is an expression with an object type or an incomplete
2732/// type other than void.
2733static bool IsCForbiddenLValueType(ASTContext &C, QualType T) {
2734 return ((T->isVoidType() && !T.hasQualifiers()) ||
2735 T->isFunctionType());
2736}
2737
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002738ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002739Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2740 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002741 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002742 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002743 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2744 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002745
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002746 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002747
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002748 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002749 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002750 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002751 Context.DependentTy,
2752 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
2753 RLoc));
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002754 }
2755
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002756 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002757 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002758 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2759 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2760 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002761 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002762 }
2763
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002764 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002765}
2766
2767
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002768ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002769Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2770 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2771 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2772 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002773
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002774 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002775 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2776 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2777 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002778
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002779 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002780 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
2781 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002782
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002783 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002784 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002785 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002786 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002787 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2788 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002789 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2790 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2791 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2792 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002793 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002794 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2795 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002796 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002797 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002798 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002799 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2800 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002801 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002802 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002803 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002804 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2805 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2806 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002807 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002808 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002809 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2810 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2811 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2812 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002813 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002814 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002815 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002816 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
2817 if (VK != VK_RValue)
2818 OK = OK_VectorComponent;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002819
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002820 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2821 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002822 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2823 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002824 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002825 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2826 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2827 // force the promotion here.
2828 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2829 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002830 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002831 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002832 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2833
2834 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2835 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002836 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002837 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2838 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2839 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2840 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002841 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002842 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002843 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2844
2845 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2846 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002847 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002848 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002849 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2850 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002851 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002852 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002853 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002854 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2855 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002856
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002857 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002858 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2859 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002860 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2861
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002862 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002863 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2864 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002865 // incomplete types are not object types.
2866 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2867 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2868 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2869 return ExprError();
2870 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002871
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002872 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2873 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2874 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2875 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002876
2877 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
2878 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
2879 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002880 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002881 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002882 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2883 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002884 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002885
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002886 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002887 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002888 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2889 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2890 return ExprError();
2891 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002892
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002893 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
2894 !IsCForbiddenLValueType(Context, ResultType));
2895
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002896 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00002897 ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002898}
2899
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002900/// Check an ext-vector component access expression.
2901///
2902/// VK should be set in advance to the value kind of the base
2903/// expression.
2904static QualType
2905CheckExtVectorComponent(Sema &S, QualType baseType, ExprValueKind &VK,
2906 SourceLocation OpLoc, const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002907 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002908 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2909 // see FIXME there.
2910 //
2911 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2912 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002913 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002914
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002915 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002916 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002917
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002918 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002919 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2920 // to be selected.
2921 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002922
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002923 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2924 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002925 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002926
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002927 bool HasRepeated = false;
2928 bool HasIndex[16] = {};
2929
2930 int Idx;
2931
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002932 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2933 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002934 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002935 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2936 HalvingSwizzle = true;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002937 } else if (!HexSwizzle &&
2938 (Idx = vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr)) != -1) {
2939 do {
2940 if (HasIndex[Idx]) HasRepeated = true;
2941 HasIndex[Idx] = true;
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002942 compStr++;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002943 } while (*compStr && (Idx = vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr)) != -1);
2944 } else {
2945 if (HexSwizzle) compStr++;
2946 while ((Idx = vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr)) != -1) {
2947 if (HasIndex[Idx]) HasRepeated = true;
2948 HasIndex[Idx] = true;
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002949 compStr++;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002950 }
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002951 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002952
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002953 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002954 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2955 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002956 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002957 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002958 return QualType();
2959 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002960
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002961 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2962 // operates on.
2963 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002964 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002965
2966 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002967 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002968
2969 while (*compStr) {
2970 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002971 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002972 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2973 return QualType();
2974 }
2975 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002976 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002977
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002978 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002979 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002980 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002981 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002982 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002983 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002984 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002985 if (HexSwizzle)
2986 CompSize--;
2987
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002988 if (CompSize == 1)
2989 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002990
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002991 if (HasRepeated) VK = VK_RValue;
2992
2993 QualType VT = S.Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002994 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002995 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00002996 for (unsigned i = 0, E = S.ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2997 if (S.ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2998 return S.Context.getTypedefType(S.ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002999 }
3000 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00003001}
3002
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003003static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003004 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00003005 const Selector &Sel,
3006 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003007 if (Member)
3008 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
3009 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003010 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003011 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003012
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003013 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
3014 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003015 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
3016 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003017 return D;
3018 }
3019 return 0;
3020}
3021
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003022static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
3023 IdentifierInfo *Member,
3024 const Selector &Sel,
3025 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003026 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
3027 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003028 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003029 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003030 if (Member)
3031 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
3032 GDecl = PD;
3033 break;
3034 }
3035 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003036 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003037 GDecl = OMD;
3038 break;
3039 }
3040 }
3041 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003042 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003043 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
3044 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003045 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
3046 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00003047 if (GDecl)
3048 return GDecl;
3049 }
3050 }
3051 return GDecl;
3052}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00003053
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003054ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003055Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003056 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003057 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3058 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003059 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003060 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003061 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
3062 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
3063 //
3064 // T* t;
3065 // t.f;
3066 //
3067 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
3068 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
3069 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
3070 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003071 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
3073 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003074 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003075 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003076 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003077 return ExprError();
3078 }
3079 }
3080
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003081 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
3082 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003083 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003084
3085 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
3086 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003087 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003088 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003089 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003090 SS.getRange(),
3091 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003092 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003093}
3094
3095/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
3096/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
3097/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
3098static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
3099 Expr *BaseExpr,
3100 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003101 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003102 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003103 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
3104 // diagnostics.
3105 if (!BaseExpr)
3106 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003107
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00003108 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
3109 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003110}
3111
3112// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
3113// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
3114// type. The restriction here is:
3115//
3116// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
3117// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
3118// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
3119//
3120// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
3121// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
3122// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
3123// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
3124bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
3125 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003126 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003128 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
3129 if (!BaseRT) {
3130 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
3131 // dependent.
3132 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
3133 return false;
3134 }
3135 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003136
3137 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003138 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
3139 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003140 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003141 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003142
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003143 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00003144 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
3145 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
3146 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003147
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00003148 if (!DC->isRecord())
3149 continue;
3150
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003151 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00003152 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003153
3154 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
3155 return false;
3156 }
3157
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003158 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003159 return true;
3160}
3161
3162static bool
3163LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
3164 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003165 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3166 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003167 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
3168 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00003169 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003170 << BaseRange))
3171 return true;
3172
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003173 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
3174 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
3175 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
3176
3177 bool MOUS;
3178 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
3179 return false;
3180 }
3181
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003182 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
3183 if (SS.isSet()) {
3184 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
3185 // nested-name-specifier.
3186 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
3187
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00003188 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003189 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
3190 << SS.getRange() << DC;
3191 return true;
3192 }
3193
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003194 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003195
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003196 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
3197 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
3198 << DC << SS.getRange();
3199 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003200 }
3201 }
3202
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003203 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
3204 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003205
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003206 if (!R.empty())
3207 return false;
3208
3209 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
3210 // for typos.
3211 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003212 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003213 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003214 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
3215 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
3216 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003217 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3218 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003219 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
3220 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3221 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003222 return false;
3223 } else {
3224 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003225 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003226 }
3227
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003228 return false;
3229}
3230
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003231ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003232Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003233 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003234 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003235 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003236 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003237 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003238 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
3239 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003240 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003241 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3242 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003243 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003244
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003245 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003246
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003247 // Implicit member accesses.
3248 if (!Base) {
3249 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
3250 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3251 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
3252 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003253 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003254 return ExprError();
3255
3256 // Explicit member accesses.
3257 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003258 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003259 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003260 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003261
3262 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3263 Owned(Base);
3264 return ExprError();
3265 }
3266
3267 if (Result.get())
3268 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00003269
3270 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
3271 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003272 }
3273
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003274 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003275 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3276 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003277}
3278
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003279ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003280Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003281 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
3282 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003283 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003284 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003285 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
3286 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003287 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003288 if (IsArrow) {
3289 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
3290 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3291 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003292 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003293
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003294 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003295 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
3296 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
3297 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298
3299 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00003300 return ExprError();
3301
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003302 if (R.empty()) {
3303 // Rederive where we looked up.
3304 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
3305 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
3306 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003307
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003308 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003309 << MemberName << DC
3310 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003311 return ExprError();
3312 }
3313
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003314 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
3315 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
3316 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
3317 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
3318 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
3319 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
3320 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
3321 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
3322 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
3323 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003324 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003325 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003326 return ExprError();
3327
3328 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
3329 // result.
3330 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00003331 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
3332 // pick a member.
3333 R.suppressDiagnostics();
3334
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003335 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00003336 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003337 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
3338 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003339 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003340 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00003341 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003342
3343 return Owned(MemExpr);
3344 }
3345
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003346 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003347 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003348 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
3349
3350 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
3351
3352 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3353 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3354 // error cases.
3355 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
3356 return ExprError();
3357
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003358 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
3359 if (!BaseExpr) {
3360 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003361 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003362 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003363
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00003364 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
3365 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
3366 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
3367 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003368 }
3369
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
3371 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3372 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
3373 // explicitly qualified.
3374 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
3375 ShouldCheckUse = false;
3376 }
3377
3378 // Check the use of this member.
3379 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
3380 Owned(BaseExpr);
3381 return ExprError();
3382 }
3383
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00003384 // Perform a property load on the base regardless of whether we
3385 // actually need it for the declaration.
3386 if (BaseExpr->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
3387 ConvertPropertyForRValue(BaseExpr);
3388
John McCalldfa1edb2010-11-23 20:48:44 +00003389 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl))
3390 return BuildFieldReferenceExpr(*this, BaseExpr, IsArrow,
3391 SS, FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003392
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00003393 if (IndirectFieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(MemberDecl))
3394 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
3395 // (C++ [class.union]).
3396 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00003397 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00003398
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003399 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3400 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3401 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003402 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003403 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003404 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003405 }
3406
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003407 if (CXXMethodDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003408 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3409 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003410 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003411 MemberFn->getType(),
3412 MemberFn->isInstance() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue,
3413 OK_Ordinary));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003414 }
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003415 assert(!isa<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl) && "member function not C++ method?");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003416
3417 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3418 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3419 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003420 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003421 Enum->getType(), VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003422 }
3423
3424 Owned(BaseExpr);
3425
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003426 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003427 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003428 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003429 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3430 else
3431 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3432 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003433
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003434 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3435 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003436 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003437 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003438}
3439
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003440/// Given that normal member access failed on the given expression,
3441/// and given that the expression's type involves builtin-id or
3442/// builtin-Class, decide whether substituting in the redefinition
3443/// types would be profitable. The redefinition type is whatever
3444/// this translation unit tried to typedef to id/Class; we store
3445/// it to the side and then re-use it in places like this.
3446static bool ShouldTryAgainWithRedefinitionType(Sema &S, Expr *&base) {
3447 const ObjCObjectPointerType *opty
3448 = base->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3449 if (!opty) return false;
3450
3451 const ObjCObjectType *ty = opty->getObjectType();
3452
3453 QualType redef;
3454 if (ty->isObjCId()) {
3455 redef = S.Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
3456 } else if (ty->isObjCClass()) {
3457 redef = S.Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
3458 } else {
3459 return false;
3460 }
3461
3462 // Do the substitution as long as the redefinition type isn't just a
3463 // possibly-qualified pointer to builtin-id or builtin-Class again.
3464 opty = redef->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3465 if (opty && !opty->getObjectType()->getInterface() != 0)
3466 return false;
3467
3468 S.ImpCastExprToType(base, redef, CK_BitCast);
3469 return true;
3470}
3471
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003472/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3473/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3474/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3475/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3476/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3477/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3478/// an ordinary member expression.
3479///
3480/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3481/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003482ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003483Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003484 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003485 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003486 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003487 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003488
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003489 // Perform default conversions.
3490 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
John McCall5e3c67b2010-12-15 04:42:30 +00003491 if (IsArrow) DefaultLvalueConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003492
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003493 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003494 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3495
3496 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3497 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003498
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003499 // For later type-checking purposes, turn arrow accesses into dot
3500 // accesses. The only access type we support that doesn't follow
3501 // the C equivalence "a->b === (*a).b" is ObjC property accesses,
3502 // and those never use arrows, so this is unaffected.
3503 if (IsArrow) {
3504 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3505 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3506 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *Ptr
3507 = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
3508 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3509 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3510 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3511 // struct MyRecord foo;
3512 // foo->bar
3513 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3514 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3515 // by now.
3516 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3517 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
3518 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
3519 IsArrow = false;
3520 } else {
3521 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3522 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3523 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003524 }
3525 }
3526
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003527 // Handle field access to simple records.
3528 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3529 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3530 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
3531 return ExprError();
3532
3533 // Returning valid-but-null is how we indicate to the caller that
3534 // the lookup result was filled in.
3535 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003536 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003537
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003538 // Handle ivar access to Objective-C objects.
3539 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003540 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003541
3542 // There are three cases for the base type:
3543 // - builtin id (qualified or unqualified)
3544 // - builtin Class (qualified or unqualified)
3545 // - an interface
3546 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface();
3547 if (!IDecl) {
3548 // There's an implicit 'isa' ivar on all objects.
3549 // But we only actually find it this way on objects of type 'id',
3550 // apparently.
3551 if (OTy->isObjCId() && Member->isStr("isa"))
3552 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, IsArrow, MemberLoc,
3553 Context.getObjCClassType()));
3554
3555 if (ShouldTryAgainWithRedefinitionType(*this, BaseExpr))
3556 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3557 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3558 goto fail;
3559 }
3560
3561 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
3562 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
3563
3564 if (!IV) {
3565 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3566 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3567 LookupMemberName);
3568 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3569 IsArrow ? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3570 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
3571 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
3572 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
3573 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3574 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
3575 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3576 IV->getNameAsString());
3577 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3578 << IV->getDeclName();
3579 } else {
3580 Res.clear();
3581 Res.setLookupName(Member);
3582
3583 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
3584 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
3585 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3586 return ExprError();
3587 }
3588 }
3589
3590 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3591 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3592 // error cases.
3593 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3594 return ExprError();
3595
3596 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3597 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3598 return ExprError();
3599 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3600 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3601 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3602 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3603 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3604 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3605 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3606 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3607 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3608 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3609 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3610 // AST for a function decl.
3611 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
3612 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
3613 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3614 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3615 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
3616 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3617 }
3618
3619 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3620 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
3621 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
3622 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
3623 << IV->getDeclName();
3624 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3625 // @protected
3626 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
3627 << IV->getDeclName();
3628 }
3629
3630 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3631 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
3632 IsArrow));
3633 }
3634
3635 // Objective-C property access.
3636 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT;
3637 if (!IsArrow && (OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())) {
3638 // This actually uses the base as an r-value.
3639 DefaultLvalueConversion(BaseExpr);
3640 assert(Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(BaseType, BaseExpr->getType()));
3641
3642 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3643
3644 const ObjCObjectType *OT = OPT->getObjectType();
3645
3646 // id, with and without qualifiers.
3647 if (OT->isObjCId()) {
3648 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
3649 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3650 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(OPT, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3651 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3652 // Check the use of this declaration
3653 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3654 return ExprError();
3655
3656 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3657 VK_LValue,
3658 OK_ObjCProperty,
3659 MemberLoc,
3660 BaseExpr));
3661 }
3662
3663 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3664 // Check the use of this method.
3665 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3666 return ExprError();
3667 Selector SetterSel =
3668 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3669 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3670 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3671 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(OPT, /*Property id*/0,
3672 SetterSel, Context))
3673 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3674 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3675
3676 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
3677 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
3678 IsCForbiddenLValueType(Context, PType))
3679 VK = VK_RValue;
3680 ExprObjectKind OK = (VK == VK_RValue ? OK_Ordinary : OK_ObjCProperty);
3681
3682 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(OMD, SMD, PType,
3683 VK, OK,
3684 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3685 }
3686 }
3687
3688 if (ShouldTryAgainWithRedefinitionType(*this, BaseExpr))
3689 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3690 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3691
3692 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3693 << MemberName << BaseType);
3694 }
3695
3696 // 'Class', unqualified only.
3697 if (OT->isObjCClass()) {
3698 // Only works in a method declaration (??!).
3699 ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl();
3700 if (!MD) {
3701 if (ShouldTryAgainWithRedefinitionType(*this, BaseExpr))
3702 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3703 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3704
3705 goto fail;
3706 }
3707
3708 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3709 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003710 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3711 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003712 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3713 // Check the use of this method.
3714 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3715 return ExprError();
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003716 } else
Fariborz Jahanian74b27562010-12-03 23:37:08 +00003717 Getter = IFace->lookupPrivateMethod(Sel, false);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003718 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3719 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3720 Selector SetterSel =
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003721 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3722 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003723 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3724 if (!Setter) {
3725 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3726 // methods.
Fariborz Jahanian74b27562010-12-03 23:37:08 +00003727 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateMethod(SetterSel, false);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003728 }
3729 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3730 if (!Setter)
3731 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003732
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003733 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3734 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003735
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003736 if (Getter || Setter) {
3737 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003738
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003739 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
3740 if (Getter) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003741 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003742 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
3743 IsCForbiddenLValueType(Context, PType))
3744 VK = VK_RValue;
3745 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003746 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3747 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003748 }
3749 ExprObjectKind OK = (VK == VK_RValue ? OK_Ordinary : OK_ObjCProperty);
3750
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003751 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00003752 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(Getter, Setter,
3753 PType, VK, OK,
3754 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003755 }
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003756
3757 if (ShouldTryAgainWithRedefinitionType(*this, BaseExpr))
3758 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3759 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3760
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003761 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003762 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003763 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003764
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003765 // Normal property access.
3766 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3767 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003768 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003769
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003770 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003771 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall5e3c67b2010-12-15 04:42:30 +00003772 // FIXME: this expr should store IsArrow.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003773 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCall5e3c67b2010-12-15 04:42:30 +00003774 ExprValueKind VK = (IsArrow ? VK_LValue : BaseExpr->getValueKind());
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003775 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(*this, BaseType, VK, OpLoc,
3776 Member, MemberLoc);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003777 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003778 return ExprError();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00003779
3780 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, VK, BaseExpr,
3781 *Member, MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003782 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003783
John McCall028d3972010-12-15 16:46:44 +00003784 // Adjust builtin-sel to the appropriate redefinition type if that's
3785 // not just a pointer to builtin-sel again.
3786 if (IsArrow &&
3787 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCSel) &&
3788 !Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType->isObjCSelType()) {
3789 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType, CK_BitCast);
3790 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3791 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3792 }
3793
3794 // Failure cases.
3795 fail:
3796
3797 // There's a possible road to recovery for function types.
3798 const FunctionType *Fun = 0;
3799
3800 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3801 if ((Fun = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) {
3802 // fall out, handled below.
3803
3804 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3805 // type *foo;
3806 // foo.bar
3807 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3808 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3809 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3810 // the appropriate pointer type
3811 } else if (Ptr->getPointeeType()->isRecordType() &&
3812 MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3813 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3814 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
3815 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
3816
3817 // Recurse as an -> access.
3818 IsArrow = true;
3819 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3820 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3821 }
3822 } else {
3823 Fun = BaseType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3824 }
3825
3826 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
3827 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
3828 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3829 // call, and continue on.
3830 if (Fun || BaseType == Context.OverloadTy) {
3831 bool TryCall;
3832 if (BaseType == Context.OverloadTy) {
3833 TryCall = true;
3834 } else {
3835 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fun)) {
3836 TryCall = (FPT->getNumArgs() == 0);
3837 } else {
3838 TryCall = true;
3839 }
3840
3841 if (TryCall) {
3842 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3843 TryCall = (!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3844 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
3845 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isRecordType());
3846 }
3847 }
3848
3849
3850 if (TryCall) {
3851 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3852 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3853 << QualType(Fun, 0)
3854 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
3855
3856 ExprResult NewBase
3857 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
3858 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
3859 return ExprError();
3860 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3861
3862
3863 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3864 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3865
3866 return LookupMemberExpr(R, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
3867 ObjCImpDecl, HasTemplateArgs);
3868 }
3869 }
3870
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003871 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3872 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3873
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003874 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003875}
3876
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003877/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3878/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3879/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3880/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3881/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3882///
3883/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3884/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3885/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3886/// only be called
3887/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3888/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3889/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003890ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall5e3c67b2010-12-15 04:42:30 +00003891 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3892 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
3893 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3894 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3895 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
3896 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003897 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3898 return ExprError();
3899
3900 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3901
3902 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003903 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003904 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3905 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003906 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003907
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003908 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003909 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3910
3911 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3912 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3913 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3914
3915 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003916 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003917 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3918 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003919
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003920 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3921 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003923 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3924 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003925 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003926 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003927 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003928 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3929 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003930
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003931 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3932 Owned(Base);
3933 return ExprError();
3934 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003935
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003936 if (Result.get()) {
3937 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3938 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3939 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3940 // call now.
3941 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3942 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003943 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003944
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003945 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003946 }
3947
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003948 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003949 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3950 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003951 }
3952
3953 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003954}
3955
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003956ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003957 FunctionDecl *FD,
3958 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003959 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003960 Diag(CallLoc,
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003961 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003962 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003963 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003964 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003965 return ExprError();
3966 }
3967
3968 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3969 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003970
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003971 // Instantiate the expression.
3972 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3973 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003974
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003975 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003976 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3977 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3978 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003979
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003980 ExprResult Result;
3981 {
3982 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
3983 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
3984 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
3985 // default argument expression appears.
Nico Weber15d5c832010-11-30 04:44:33 +00003986 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
Nico Weber08e41a62010-11-29 18:19:25 +00003987 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3988 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003989 if (Result.isInvalid())
3990 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003991
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003992 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3993 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003994 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003995 InitializationKind Kind
3996 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3997 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3998 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003999
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00004000 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
4001 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
4002 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
4003 if (Result.isInvalid())
4004 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004005
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00004006 // Build the default argument expression.
4007 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
4008 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00004009 }
4010
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00004011 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
4012 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
4013 // be properly destroyed.
4014 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
4015 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00004016 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
4017 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
4018 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
4019 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
4020 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
4021 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00004022
4023 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00004024 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
4025 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00004026 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00004027 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00004028}
4029
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004030/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
4031/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
4032/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
4033/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
4034/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
4035/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004036bool
4037Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004038 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004039 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004040 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4041 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004042 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004043 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
4044 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00004045 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004046
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004047 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
4048 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
4049 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4050 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
4051 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00004052 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00004053 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00004054 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004055 }
4056
4057 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
4058 // them.
4059 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
4060 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
4061 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
4062 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00004063 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00004064 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004065 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
4066 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
4067 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00004068 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004069 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004070 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004071 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004072 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004073 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00004074 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
4075 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
4076 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
4077 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
4078 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004079 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00004080 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004081 if (Invalid)
4082 return true;
4083 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
4084 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
4085 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004086
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004087 return false;
4088}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004089
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004090bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4091 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4092 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4093 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
4094 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4095 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00004096 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004097 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4098 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
4099 bool Invalid = false;
4100 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
4101 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
4102 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
4103 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004104 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004105 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004106 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004107
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004108 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004109 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
4110 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004111
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004112 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4113 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004114 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004115 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004116 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004117
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00004118 // Pass the argument
4119 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
4120 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
4121 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00004122
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00004123 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004124 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
4125 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004126 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00004127 SourceLocation(),
4128 Owned(Arg));
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00004129 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4130 return true;
4131
4132 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00004133 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00004134 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004135
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004136 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004137 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00004138 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
4139 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004140
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00004141 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00004142 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004143 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004144 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004145
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004146 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00004147 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004148 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00004149 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004150 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00004151 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00004152 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004153 }
4154 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00004155 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004156}
4157
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004158/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004159/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
4160/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004161ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004162Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004163 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004164 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004165
4166 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004167 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004168 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4169 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004170
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004171 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004172
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004173 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00004174 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
4175 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
4176 if (NumArgs > 0) {
4177 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
4178 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00004179 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00004180 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
4181 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004182
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00004183 NumArgs = 0;
4184 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004185
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00004186 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004187 VK_RValue, RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00004188 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004189
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00004190 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004191 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00004192 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
4193 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00004194 bool Dependent = false;
4195 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
4196 Dependent = true;
4197 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
4198 Dependent = true;
4199
4200 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004201 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004202 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
4203 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00004204
4205 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
4206 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
4207 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004208 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00004209
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004210 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
4211
4212 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
4213 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4214 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
4215 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
4216 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
4217 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
4218 // method template.
4219 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00004220 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
4221 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00004222 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004223
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004224 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004225 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004226 }
4227
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004228 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004229 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004230 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004231 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004232 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00004233 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004234 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004235
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004236 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004237 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004238 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
4239 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00004240 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
4241 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004242 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004243 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(FPT->getResultType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004244
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004245 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
Abramo Bagnara6c572f12010-12-03 21:39:42 +00004246 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004247 NumArgs, ResultTy, VK,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004248 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004249
4250 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
4251 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004252 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004253 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00004254
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004255 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004256 RParenLoc))
4257 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004258
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004259 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004260 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004261 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004262 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4263 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004264 }
4265 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004266 }
4267
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004268 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004269 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004270 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004271
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00004272 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00004273 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4274 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
4275 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
4276 RParenLoc);
4277 }
4278
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004279 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00004280 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4281 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4282 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4283
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004284 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
4285 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4286
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004287 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
4288}
4289
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004290/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4291/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004292/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4293/// block-pointer type.
4294///
4295/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004296ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004297Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4298 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4299 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4300 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4301 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4302
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00004303 // Promote the function operand.
4304 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
4305
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004306 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
4307 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004308 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
4309 Args, NumArgs,
4310 Context.BoolTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004311 VK_RValue,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004312 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004313
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004314 const FunctionType *FuncT;
4315 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
4316 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4317 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004318 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004319 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004320 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4321 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004322 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004323 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004324 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004325 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004326 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004327 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004328 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4329 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4330
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004331 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004332 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004333 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004334 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004335 return ExprError();
4336
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004337 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004338 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004339 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getResultType()));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004340
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004341 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004342 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004343 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004344 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004345 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004346 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004347
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004348 if (FDecl) {
4349 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4350 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4351 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00004352 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004353 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
4354 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4355 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004356 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4357 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004358 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004359
4360 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4361 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4362 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4363 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004364 }
4365
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004366 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004367 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
4368 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004369
4370 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004371 InitializedEntity Entity
4372 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
4373 Proto->getArgType(i));
4374 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
4375 SourceLocation(),
4376 Owned(Arg));
4377 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4378 return true;
4379
4380 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
4381
4382 } else {
4383 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004384 }
4385
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00004386 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4387 Arg->getType(),
4388 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
4389 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
4390 return ExprError();
4391
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004392 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004393 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004394 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004395
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004396 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4397 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004398 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
4399 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004400
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00004401 // Check for sentinels
4402 if (NDecl)
4403 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004404
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004405 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004406 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004407 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004408 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004409
Fariborz Jahanian67aba812010-11-30 17:35:24 +00004410 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
4411 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004412 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004413 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004414 return ExprError();
4415 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004416
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004417 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004418}
4419
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004420ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004421Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004422 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004423 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00004424 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004425 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004426
4427 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4428 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
4429 if (!TInfo)
4430 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
4431
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004432 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004433}
4434
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004435ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004436Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004437 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004438 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00004439
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004440 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00004441 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
4442 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
4443 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
4444 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4445 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004446 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004447 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
4448 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00004449 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
4450 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004451 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004452 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004453 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004454 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004455
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004456 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00004457 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004458 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004459 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004460 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004461 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004462 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00004463 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004464 &literalType);
4465 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004466 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004467 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004468
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00004469 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004470 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004471 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004472 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004473 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004474
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004475 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
4476 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue;
4477
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004478 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004479 VK, literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004480}
4481
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004482ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004483Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004484 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
4485 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004486 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00004487
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00004488 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004489 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004490
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004491 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4492 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004493 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004494 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004495}
4496
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004497/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
4498/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
4499static CastKind PrepareScalarCast(Sema &S, Expr *&Src, QualType DestTy) {
4500 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
4501 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
4502 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
4503
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004504 QualType SrcTy = Src->getType();
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004505 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004506 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004507
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004508 switch (SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4509 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4510 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
4511
4512 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4513 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4514 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4515 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004516 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4517 CK_BitCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004518 case Type::STK_Bool:
4519 return CK_PointerToBoolean;
4520 case Type::STK_Integral:
4521 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
4522 case Type::STK_Floating:
4523 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4524 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4525 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4526 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
4527 }
4528 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004529
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004530 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
4531 case Type::STK_Integral:
4532 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4533 case Type::STK_Pointer:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004534 if (Src->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004535 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004536 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004537 case Type::STK_Bool:
4538 return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
4539 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004540 return CK_IntegralCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004541 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004542 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004543 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004544 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4545 CK_IntegralCast);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004546 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004547 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004548 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4549 CK_IntegralToFloating);
4550 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004551 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4552 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004553 }
4554 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004555
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004556 case Type::STK_Floating:
4557 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4558 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004559 return CK_FloatingCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004560 case Type::STK_Bool:
4561 return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
4562 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004563 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004564 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004565 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4566 CK_FloatingCast);
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004567 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004568 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004569 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4570 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
4571 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004572 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4573 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
4574 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4575 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004576 }
4577 break;
4578
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004579 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
4580 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4581 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004582 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004583 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004584 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004585 case Type::STK_Floating: {
4586 QualType ET = cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType();
4587 if (S.Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
4588 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
4589 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
4590 return CK_FloatingCast;
4591 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004592 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004593 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004594 case Type::STK_Integral:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004595 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4596 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
4597 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004598 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4599 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
4600 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4601 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004602 }
4603 break;
4604
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004605 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
4606 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
4607 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004608 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004609 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004610 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
John McCall8786da72010-12-14 17:51:41 +00004611 case Type::STK_Integral: {
4612 QualType ET = cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType();
4613 if (S.Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
4614 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
4615 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
4616 return CK_IntegralCast;
4617 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004618 case Type::STK_Bool:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004619 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004620 case Type::STK_Floating:
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004621 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4622 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
4623 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004624 case Type::STK_Pointer:
4625 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
4626 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
4627 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004628 }
4629 break;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004630 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004631
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004632 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
4633 return CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004634}
4635
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004636/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004637bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType,
4638 Expr *&castExpr, CastKind& Kind, ExprValueKind &VK,
4639 CXXCastPath &BasePath, bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004640 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004641 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4642 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004643 castType, VK, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004644 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004645
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004646 // We only support r-value casts in C.
4647 VK = VK_RValue;
4648
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004649 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4650 // type needs to be scalar.
4651 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00004652 // We don't necessarily do lvalue-to-rvalue conversions on this.
4653 IgnoredValueConversions(castExpr);
4654
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004655 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004656 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004657 return false;
4658 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004659
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00004660 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
4661
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004662 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4663 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4664 return true;
4665
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004666 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004667 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004668 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4669 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004670 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004671 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4672 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004673 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004674 return false;
4675 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004676
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004677 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004678 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004679 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004680 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004681 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004682 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004683 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004684 castExpr->getType()) &&
4685 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004686 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4687 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4688 break;
4689 }
4690 }
4691 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4692 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4693 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004694 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004695 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004696 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004697
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004698 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4699 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4700 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4701 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004702
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004703 // The type we're casting to is known to be a scalar or vector.
4704
4705 // Require the operand to be a scalar or vector.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004706 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004707 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004708 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4709 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004710 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004711 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004712
4713 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004714 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004715
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004716 if (castType->isVectorType())
4717 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4718 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4719 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4720
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004721 // The source and target types are both scalars, i.e.
4722 // - arithmetic types (fundamental, enum, and complex)
4723 // - all kinds of pointers
4724 // Note that member pointers were filtered out with C++, above.
4725
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004726 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4727 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004728
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004729 // If either type is a pointer, the other type has to be either an
4730 // integer or a pointer.
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004731 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004732 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004733 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004734 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004735 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4736 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4737 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4738 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004739 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004740 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4741 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4742 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004743 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004744
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004745 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, castExpr, castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004746
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004747 if (Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004748 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4749
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004750 return false;
4751}
4752
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004753bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004754 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004755 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004756
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004757 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004758 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004759 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004760 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004761 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004762 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004763 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004764 } else
4765 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004766 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004767 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004768
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004769 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004770 return false;
4771}
4772
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004773bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004774 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004775 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004776
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004777 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004778
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004779 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4780 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004781 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4782 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4783 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4784 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004785 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004786 return false;
4787 }
4788
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004789 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004790 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4791 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004792 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4793 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4794 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4795 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004796
4797 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4798 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004799 PrepareScalarCast(*this, CastExpr, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004800
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004801 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004802 return false;
4803}
4804
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004805ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004806Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004807 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4808 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004809 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004810
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004811 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4812 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4813 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004814 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004815
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004816 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4817 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004818 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004819 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004820
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004821 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004822}
4823
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004824ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004825Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004826 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00004827 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004828 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004829 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004830 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004831 Kind, VK, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004832 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004833
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004834 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004835 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004836 VK, Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004837 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004838}
4839
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004840/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4841/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004842ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004843Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004844 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4845 if (!E)
4846 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004847
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004848 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004849
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004850 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004851 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4852 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004853
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004854 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4855
4856 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004857}
4858
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004859ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004860Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004861 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004862 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004863 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004864 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004865 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004866
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004867 // Check for an altivec literal,
4868 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004869 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4870 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4871 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4872 return ExprError();
4873 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004874 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4875 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4876 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4877 }
4878 else
4879 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4880 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004881
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004882 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4883 // then handle it as such.
4884 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004885 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4886 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4887 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4888
4889 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4890 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004891 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4892 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004893 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4894 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004895 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004896 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004897 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004898 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004899 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004900 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4901 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004902 }
4903}
4904
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004905ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004906 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004907 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004908 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004909 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4910 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004911 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4912 Expr *expr;
4913 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4914 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4915 else
4916 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004917 return Owned(expr);
4918}
4919
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004920/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4921/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004922/// C99 6.5.15
4923QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004924 Expr *&SAVE, ExprValueKind &VK,
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00004925 ExprObjectKind &OK,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004926 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004927 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4928 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4929 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4930 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4931 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4932 return QualType();
4933
4934 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4935 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4936 return QualType();
4937
4938 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4939 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4940 }
4941
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004942 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4943 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00004944 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE,
4945 VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004946
4947 VK = VK_RValue;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00004948 OK = OK_Ordinary;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004949
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004950 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004951 if (SAVE) {
4952 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4953 }
4954 else
4955 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004956 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4957 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4958 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4959 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004960
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004961 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004962 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004963 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4964 // Throw an error if its not either.
4965 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4966 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4967 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4968 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4969 << CondTy;
4970 return QualType();
4971 }
4972 }
4973 else {
4974 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4975 << CondTy;
4976 return QualType();
4977 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004978 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004979
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004980 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004981 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4982 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004983
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004984 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4985 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4986 // built in select.
4987 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4988 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4989 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4990 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4991 << CondTy;
4992 return QualType();
4993 }
4994 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4995 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4996 << CondTy;
4997 return QualType();
4998 }
4999 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
5000 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
5001 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
5002 }
5003
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00005004 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
5005 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005006 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
5007 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
5008 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005009 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005010
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00005011 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
5012 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005013 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
5014 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00005015 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005016 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00005017 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005018 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005019 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005020 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005021
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00005022 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00005023 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005024 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
5025 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
5026 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5027 << RHS->getSourceRange();
5028 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
5029 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5030 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005031 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5032 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00005033 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00005034 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00005035 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
5036 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005037 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005038 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005039 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005040 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005041 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00005042 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005043 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005044 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005045 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_NullToPointer);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005046 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00005047 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005048
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005049 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
5050 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
5051 QuestionLoc);
5052 if (!compositeType.isNull())
5053 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005054
5055
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005056 // Handle block pointer types.
5057 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
5058 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
5059 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5060 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005061 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
5062 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005063 return destType;
5064 }
5065 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005066 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005067 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005068 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005069 // We have 2 block pointer types.
5070 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
5071 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005072 return LHSTy;
5073 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005074 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005075 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5076 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005078 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
5079 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005080 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005081 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005082 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
5083 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
5084 // to get a consistent AST.
5085 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005086 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5087 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005088 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005089 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005090 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005091 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
5092 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00005093 return LHSTy;
5094 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005095
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005096 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
5097 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
5098 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005099 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5100 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005101
5102 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
5103 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5104 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005105 QualType destPointee
5106 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005107 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005108 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005109 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005110 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005111 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005112 return destType;
5113 }
5114 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005115 QualType destPointee
5116 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005117 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005118 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005119 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005120 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005121 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005122 return destType;
5123 }
5124
5125 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
5126 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
5127 return LHSTy;
5128 }
5129 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
5130 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5131 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
5132 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
5133 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
5134 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
5135 // to get a consistent AST.
5136 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005137 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5138 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005139 return incompatTy;
5140 }
5141 // The pointer types are compatible.
5142 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
5143 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
5144 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
5145 // type.
5146 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
5147 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005148 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
5149 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005150 return LHSTy;
5151 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005153 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
5154 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005155 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
5156 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
5157 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005158 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005159 return RHSTy;
5160 }
5161 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
5162 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
5163 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005164 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00005165 return LHSTy;
5166 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00005167
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00005168 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00005169 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5170 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005171 return QualType();
5172}
5173
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005174/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
5175/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
5176QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5177 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5178 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
5179 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005180
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005181 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
5182 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
5183 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
5184 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005185 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005186 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005187 return LHSTy;
5188 }
5189 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005190 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005191 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005192 return RHSTy;
5193 }
5194 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
5195 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005196 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005197 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005198 return LHSTy;
5199 }
5200 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005201 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005202 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005203 return RHSTy;
5204 }
5205 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
5206 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005207 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005208 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005209 return LHSTy;
5210 }
5211 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005212 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType))) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005213 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005214 return RHSTy;
5215 }
5216 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
5217 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005218
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005219 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
5220 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
5221 return LHSTy;
5222 }
5223 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5224 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5225 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005226
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005227 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
5228 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
5229 // type. This allows
5230 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
5231 // where B is a subclass of A.
5232 //
5233 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
5234 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
5235 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
5236 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005237
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005238 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
5239 // It could return the composite type.
5240 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
5241 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
5242 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
5243 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
5244 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
5245 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
5246 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
5247 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
5248 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
5249 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
5250 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
5251 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
5252 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
5253 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005254 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005255 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
5256 ;
5257 else {
5258 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5259 << LHSTy << RHSTy
5260 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
5261 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005262 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5263 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005264 return incompatTy;
5265 }
5266 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005267 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
5268 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005269 return compositeType;
5270 }
5271 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
5272 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5273 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5274 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5275 QualType destPointee
5276 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5277 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5278 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005279 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005280 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005281 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005282 return destType;
5283 }
5284 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5285 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5286 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5287 QualType destPointee
5288 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5289 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5290 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005291 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005292 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005293 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005294 return destType;
5295 }
5296 return QualType();
5297}
5298
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00005299/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005300/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00005301ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005302 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005303 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
5304 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00005305 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
5306 // was the condition.
5307 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005308 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
5309 if (isLHSNull) {
5310 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
5311 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005312
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005313 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00005314 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00005315 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00005316 SAVEExpr, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005317 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005318 return ExprError();
5319
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00005320 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005321 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
5322 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00005323 result, VK, OK));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005324}
5325
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005326// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005327// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005328// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
5329// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
5330// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005332Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5333 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005334
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005335 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005336 (Context.hasSameType(rhsType, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) ||
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005337 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005338 (Context.hasSameType(lhsType, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)))) {
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005339 return Compatible;
5340 }
5341
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005342 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005343 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5344 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005345
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005346 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005347 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5348 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005349
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005350 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005351
5352 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
5353 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
5354 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00005355 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005356 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005357 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005358
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005359 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
5360 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005361 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005362 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005363 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005364 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005365
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005366 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005367 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
5368 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005369 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005370
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005371 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005372 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005373 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005374
5375 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005376 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
5377 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005378 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005379 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005380 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005381 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5382 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5383 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
5384 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
5385 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
5386 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005387 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005388 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005389 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005390 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005391
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005392 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005393 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005394 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005395 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005396
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005397 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
5398 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
5399 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
5400 // warning can be disabled.
5401 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
5402 return ConvTy;
5403 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
5404 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005405
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005406 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
5407 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
5408 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
5409 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
5410 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
5411 do {
5412 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5413 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005414
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005415 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5416 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5417 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005418
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005419 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00005420 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005421 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005422
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005423 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005424 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005425 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005426 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005427}
5428
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005429/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
5430/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
5431/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
5432// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005433Sema::AssignConvertType
5434Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005435 QualType rhsType) {
5436 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005437
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005438 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005439 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5440 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005441
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005442 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5443 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5444 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005445
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005446 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005447
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005448 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005449 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005450 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005451
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00005452 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5453 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5454 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
5455 }
5456 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005457 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005458 return ConvTy;
5459}
5460
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005461/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
5462/// for assignment compatibility.
5463Sema::AssignConvertType
5464Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005465 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5466 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005467 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5468 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005469 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005470 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005471 }
5472 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5473 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005474 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5475 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005476 return IncompatiblePointer;
5477 return Compatible;
5478 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005479 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005480 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005481 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005482 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5483 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5484 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5485 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5486 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
5487 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005488
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005489 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5490 return Compatible;
5491 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5492 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005493 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005494}
5495
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005496Sema::AssignConvertType
5497Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5498 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what
5499 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
5500 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
5501 // usually happen on valid code.
5502 OpaqueValueExpr rhs(rhsType, VK_RValue);
5503 Expr *rhsPtr = &rhs;
5504 CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
5505
5506 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rhsPtr, K);
5507}
5508
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005509/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
5510/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005511/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
5512///
5513/// int a, *pint;
5514/// short *pshort;
5515/// struct foo *pfoo;
5516///
5517/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5518/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
5519/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
5520/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5521///
5522/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005523/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005524///
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005525/// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005526Sema::AssignConvertType
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005527Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rhs,
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005528 CastKind &Kind) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005529 QualType rhsType = rhs->getType();
5530
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005531 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
5532 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005533 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
5534 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005535
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005536 if (lhsType == rhsType) {
5537 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00005538 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005539 }
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00005540
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005541 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005542 (Context.hasSameType(rhsType, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) ||
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005543 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00005544 (Context.hasSameType(lhsType, Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)))) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005545 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5546 return Compatible;
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005547 }
5548
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005549 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
5550 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
5551 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
5552 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
5553 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
5554 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
5555 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005556 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005557 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType)) {
5558 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00005559 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005560 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005561 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00005562 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005563 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
5564 // to the same ExtVector type.
5565 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5566 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005567 return Incompatible;
5568 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType()) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005569 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
5570 // element type.
5571 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(lhsType)->getElementType();
5572 if (elType != rhsType) {
5573 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, elType);
5574 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, elType, Kind);
5575 }
5576 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005577 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005578 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005579 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005580
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005581 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005582 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Bob Wilsonde3deea2010-12-02 00:25:15 +00005583 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
5584 // vector type and vice versa
5585 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5586 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5587 return Compatible;
5588 }
5589
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005590 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5591 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
5592 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5593 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005594 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))) {
John McCall0c6d28d2010-11-15 10:08:00 +00005595 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005596 return IncompatibleVectors;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005597 }
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00005598 }
5599 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005600 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005601
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00005602 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005603 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005604 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, rhs, lhsType);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005605 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005606 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005607
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005608 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005609 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5610 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005611 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005612 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005613
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005614 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
5615 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005616 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005617 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005618
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005619 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005620 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005621 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005622 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5623 return Compatible;
5624 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005625 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005626 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005627 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5628 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005629 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005630 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005631
5632 // Treat block pointers as objects.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005633 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType()) {
5634 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005635 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005636 }
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005637 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005638 return Incompatible;
5639 }
5640
5641 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005642 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5643 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00005644 return IntToBlockPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005645 }
5646
5647 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005648
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005649 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005650 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005651 return Compatible;
5652
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005653 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5654 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005655
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005656 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005657 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005658 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005659
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005660 return Incompatible;
5661 }
5662
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005663 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005664 if (rhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5665 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005666 return IntToPointer;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005667 }
5668
5669 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005670
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005671 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005672 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005673 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5674 return Compatible;
5675 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005676 }
5677 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005678 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005679 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005680 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005681 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5682 return Compatible;
5683 }
5684 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5685 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5686 return Compatible;
5687 return Incompatible;
5688 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005689 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005690 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005691 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5692 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005693 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005694 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005695
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005696 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5697 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005698 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005699 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005700
5701 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005702 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5703 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005704 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005705 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005706 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005707 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005708 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5709 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005710 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy) {
5711 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005712 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005713 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005714
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005715 if (lhsType->isIntegerType()) {
5716 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005717 return PointerToInt;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005718 }
5719
5720 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005721
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005722 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005723 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005724 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5725 return Compatible;
5726 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005727 }
5728 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005729 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
5730 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005731 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005732 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005733 return Incompatible;
5734 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005735
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005736 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005737 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5738 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005739 return Compatible;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005740 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005741 }
5742 return Incompatible;
5743}
5744
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005745/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5746/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005747static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005748 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5749 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5750 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005751 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005752 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005753 SourceLocation());
5754 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5755 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5756
5757 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5758 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005759 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005760 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005761 VK_RValue, Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005762}
5763
5764Sema::AssignConvertType
5765Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5766 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5767
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005768 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005769 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5770 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005771 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005772 return Incompatible;
5773
5774 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5775 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5776 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5777 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005778 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5779 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005780 it != itend; ++it) {
5781 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5782 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5783 // 1) void pointer
5784 // 2) null pointer constant
5785 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005786 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005787 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005788 InitField = *it;
5789 break;
5790 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005792 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005793 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005794 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005795 InitField = *it;
5796 break;
5797 }
5798 }
5799
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005800 Expr *rhs = rExpr;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005801 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005802 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rhs, Kind)
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005803 == Compatible) {
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005804 ImpCastExprToType(rhs, it->getType(), Kind);
5805 rExpr = rhs;
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005806 InitField = *it;
5807 break;
5808 }
5809 }
5810
5811 if (!InitField)
5812 return Incompatible;
5813
5814 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5815 return Compatible;
5816}
5817
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005818Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005819Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005820 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5821 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5822 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5823 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5824 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005825 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005826 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005827 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005828 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005829 }
5830
5831 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5832 // structures.
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00005833 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005834
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005835 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5836 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005837 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5838 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005839 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005840 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005841 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005842 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_NullToPointer);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005843 return Compatible;
5844 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005845
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005846 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005847 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005848 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005849 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005850 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005852 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005853 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005854
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005855 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005856 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00005857 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr, Kind);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005858
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005859 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5860 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005861 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5862 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5863 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5864 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005865 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005866 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context), Kind);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005867 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005868}
5869
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005870QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005871 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005872 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005873 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005874 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005875}
5876
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005877QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005878 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005879 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005880 QualType lhsType =
5881 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5882 QualType rhsType =
5883 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005884
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005885 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005886 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005887 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005888
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005889 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5890 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005891 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005892 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005893 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005894 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005895 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005896 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005897 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005898 return lhsType;
5899 }
5900
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005901 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005902 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005903 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5904 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5905 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5906 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5907 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5908 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005909 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005910 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005911 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005912 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005913
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005914 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5915 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5916 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005917 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005918 return rhsType;
5919 }
5920
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005921 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5922 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5923 bool swapped = false;
5924 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5925 swapped = true;
5926 std::swap(rex, lex);
5927 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5928 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005929
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005930 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005931 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005932 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005933 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005934 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5935 if (order > 0)
5936 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_IntegralCast);
5937 if (order >= 0) {
5938 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005939 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5940 return lhsType;
5941 }
5942 }
5943 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5944 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00005945 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType);
5946 if (order > 0)
5947 ImpCastExprToType(rex, EltTy, CK_FloatingCast);
5948 if (order >= 0) {
5949 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_VectorSplat);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005950 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5951 return lhsType;
5952 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005953 }
5954 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005955
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005956 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005957 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005958 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005959 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005960 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005961}
5962
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005963QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5964 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005965 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005966 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005967
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005968 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005969
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005970 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5971 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5972 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005973
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005974 // Check for division by zero.
5975 if (isDiv &&
5976 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005977 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005978 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005979
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005980 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005981}
5982
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005983QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005984 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005985 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005986 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5987 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005988 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5989 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5990 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005991
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005992 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005993
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005994 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5995 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005996
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005997 // Check for remainder by zero.
5998 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005999 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
6000 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006001
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006002 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006003}
6004
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006005QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006006 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006007 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6008 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6009 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
6010 return compType;
6011 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006012
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006013 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006014
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006015 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006016 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
6017 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
6018 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006019 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006020 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006021
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006022 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
6023 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006024 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006025 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
6026
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006027 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006028
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006029 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00006030 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006031
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006032 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
6033 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006034 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6035 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00006036 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006037 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006038 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006039
6040 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
6041 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
6042 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006043 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006044 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6045 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6046 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
6047 return QualType();
6048 }
6049
6050 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
6051 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
6052 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00006053 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00006054 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006055 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00006056 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00006057 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
6058 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006059 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
6060 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006061 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00006062 return QualType();
6063 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006064 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006065 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006066 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6067 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
6068 return QualType();
6069 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006070
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006071 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00006072 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
6073 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
6074 LHSTy = lex->getType();
6075 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
6076 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006077 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006078 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
6079 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00006080 return PExp->getType();
6081 }
6082 }
6083
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006084 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006085}
6086
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00006087// C99 6.5.6
6088QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006089 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
6090 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6091 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6092 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
6093 return compType;
6094 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006095
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006096 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006097
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006098 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006099
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006100 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006101 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
6102 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006103 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006104 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006105 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006107 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006108 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00006109 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006110
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006111 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006112
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006113 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
6114 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
6115 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
6116 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6117 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6118 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6119 return QualType();
6120 }
6121
6122 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
6123 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
6124 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
6125 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6126 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006127 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006128 return QualType();
6129 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006130
6131 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
6132 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
6133 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006134 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006135 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006136 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006137 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006138 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006139
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006140 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006141 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00006142 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6143 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
6144 return QualType();
6145 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006146
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006147 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006148 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
6149 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
6150 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
6151 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6152 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
6153 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006154 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006155 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
6156
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006157 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006158 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006159 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006160
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006161 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006162 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00006163 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006164
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006165 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
6166 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
6167 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
6168 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6169 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6170 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6171 return QualType();
6172 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006173
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006174 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
6175 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
6176 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6177 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006178 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006179 return QualType();
6180 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006181
6182 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
6183 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
6184 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
6185 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
6186 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006187 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
6188 << rex->getSourceRange()
6189 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006190 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006191
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00006192 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6193 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
6194 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
6195 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
6196 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
6197 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6198 return QualType();
6199 }
6200 } else {
6201 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
6202 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
6203 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
6204 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
6205 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
6206 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
6207 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6208 return QualType();
6209 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006210 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006211
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006212 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
6213 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
6214 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6215 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
6216 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006217 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00006218 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006219
6220 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00006221 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
6222 }
6223 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006224
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006225 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006226}
6227
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006228static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
6229 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
6230 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
6231 return false;
6232}
6233
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00006234// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006235QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00006236 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006237 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006238 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
6239 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006240 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006241
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006242 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
6243 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
6244 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
6245 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
6246 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6247 }
6248
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00006249 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
6250 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
6251 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6252
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006253 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
6254 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006255
John McCall1bc80af2010-12-16 19:28:59 +00006256 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
6257 // if this is a compound assignment.
6258 Expr *old_lex = lex;
6259 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6260 QualType LHSTy = lex->getType();
6261 if (isCompAssign) lex = old_lex;
6262
6263 // The RHS is simpler.
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006264 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006265
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006266 // Sanity-check shift operands
6267 llvm::APSInt Right;
6268 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00006269 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
6270 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00006271 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00006272 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
6273 else {
6274 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
6275 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
6276 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
6277 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
6278 }
6279 }
6280
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00006281 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006282 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006283}
6284
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006285static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
6286 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
6287 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
6288 return true;
6289 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
6290 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
6291 }
6292 return false;
6293}
6294
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006295// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006296QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006297 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006298 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006299
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006300 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006301 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006302 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006303
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006304 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6305 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006306
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006307 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006308 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
6309 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
6310 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006311 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6312 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6313 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00006314 //
6315 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
6316 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
6317 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
6318 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
6319 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
6320 // result.
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00006321 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6322 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006323 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006324 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00006325 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006326 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006327 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6328 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006329 << (Opc == BO_EQ
6330 || Opc == BO_LE
6331 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006332 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
6333 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
6334 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6335 // what is it always going to eval to?
6336 char always_evals_to;
6337 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006338 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006339 always_evals_to = 0; // false
6340 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006341 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006342 always_evals_to = 1; // true
6343 break;
6344 default:
6345 // best we can say is 'a constant'
6346 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
6347 break;
6348 }
6349 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6350 << 1 // array
6351 << always_evals_to);
6352 }
6353 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006354 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006355
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006356 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
6357 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
6358 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
6359 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006360
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006361 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
6362 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006363 Expr *literalString = 0;
6364 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006365 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006366 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006367 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006368 literalString = lex;
6369 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00006370 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
6371 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006372 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006373 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006374 literalString = rex;
6375 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
6376 }
6377
6378 if (literalString) {
6379 std::string resultComparison;
6380 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006381 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
6382 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
6383 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
6384 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
6385 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
6386 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006387 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
6388 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006389
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00006390 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6391 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
6392 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00006393 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006394 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00006395 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006396
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006397 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
6398 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
6399 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
6400 else {
6401 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6402 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
6403 }
6404
6405 lType = lex->getType();
6406 rType = rex->getType();
6407
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006408 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006409 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006410
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006411 if (isRelational) {
6412 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006413 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006414 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00006415 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006416 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006417 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006418
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006419 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006420 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006421 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006422
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006423 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006424 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006425 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006426 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006427
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006428 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
6429 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00006430 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006431 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006432 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006433 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006434 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006435
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006436 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006437 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
6438 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006439 if (!isRelational &&
6440 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6441 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6442 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006443 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
6444 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006445 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6446 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006447 Diag(Loc,
6448 isSFINAEContext()?
6449 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
6450 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006451 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006452
6453 if (isSFINAEContext())
6454 return QualType();
6455
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006456 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006457 return ResultTy;
6458 }
6459 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006460
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006461 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
6462 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
6463 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
6464 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
6465 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
6466 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006467 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006468 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006469 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006470 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006471 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006472 if (T.isNull()) {
6473 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6474 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6475 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006476 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006477 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006478 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006479 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006480 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006481 }
6482
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006483 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6484 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006485 return ResultTy;
6486 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006487 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
6488 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
6489 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
6490 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
6491 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
6492 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
6493 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6494 }
6495 } else if (!isRelational &&
6496 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6497 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6498 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6499 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
6500 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
6501 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6502 }
6503 } else {
6504 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006505 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006506 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006507 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006508 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006509 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006510 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00006511 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006512
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006513 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006514 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
6515 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
6516 return ResultTy;
6517
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006518 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006519 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006520 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006521 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006522 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006523 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6524 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006526 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006527 return ResultTy;
6528 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006529 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006530 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006531 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006532 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6533 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006534 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006535 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006536 return ResultTy;
6537 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006538
6539 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006540 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006541 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
6542 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006543 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
6544 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
6545 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
6546 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
6547 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
6548 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
6549 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
6550 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006551 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006552 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006553 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006554 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006555 if (T.isNull()) {
6556 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006557 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006558 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006559 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006560 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006561 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006562 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006563 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006564 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006565
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006566 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6567 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006568 return ResultTy;
6569 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006570 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006571
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006572 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006573 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006574 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6575 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006576
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006577 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00006578 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006579 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006580 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006581 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006582 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006583 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006584 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006585 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006586 if (!isRelational
6587 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
6588 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006589 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006590 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006591 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006592 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006593 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
6594 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
6595 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006596 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006597 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006598 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006599 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006600
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006601 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006602 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006603 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
6604 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006605 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006606 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006607 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006608 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006609
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006610 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
6611 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006612 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006613 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006614 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006615 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006616 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00006617 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006618 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006619 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006620 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6621 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006622 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006623 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00006624 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00006625 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006626 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
6627 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006628 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006629 bool isError = false;
6630 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
6631 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
6632 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006633 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006634 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006635 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006636 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6637 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
6638 isError = true;
6639 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006640 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006641
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006642 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006643 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00006644 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006645 if (isError)
6646 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006647 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006648
6649 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006650 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6651 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006652 else
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006653 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6654 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006655 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006656 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006657
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006658 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006659 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
6660 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006661 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006662 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006663 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006664 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
6665 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006666 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006667 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006668 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006669 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006670}
6671
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006672/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006673/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006674/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
6675/// types.
6676QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006677 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006678 bool isRelational) {
6679 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
6680 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006681 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006682 if (vType.isNull())
6683 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006684
Anton Yartsevaa4fe052010-11-18 03:19:30 +00006685 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
6686 // bool for C++, int for C
6687 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec)
6688 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy);
6689
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006690 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6691 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006692
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006693 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6694 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6695 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006696 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006697 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
6698 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
6699 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006700 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6701 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6702 << 0 // self-
6703 << 2 // "a constant"
6704 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006705 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006706
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006707 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006708 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6709 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006710 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006711 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006712
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006713 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6714 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6715 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006716 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006717 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006718
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006719 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006720 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006721 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006722 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006723 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006724 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6725
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006726 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006727 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006728 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6729}
6730
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006731inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006732 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006733 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6734 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6735 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6736 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6737
6738 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6739 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006740
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006741 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006742
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006743 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6744 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006745 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006746 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006747}
6748
6749inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006750 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6751
6752 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6753 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6754 // is a constant.
6755 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006756 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006757 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006758 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6759 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6760 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6761 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6762 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6763 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6764 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6765 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6766 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006767 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6768 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006769 }
6770 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006771
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006772 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6773 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6774 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006775
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006776 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6777 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006778
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006779 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006780 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006781
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006782 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6783 // non-overloadable operands.
6784
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006785 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6786 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006787 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6788 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6789 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006790 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006791
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006792 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6793 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6794 // The result is a bool.
6795 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006796}
6797
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006798/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6799/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6800/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6801///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006802static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006803 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6804 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00006805 if (PropExpr->isImplicitProperty()) return false;
6806
6807 ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getExplicitProperty();
6808 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6809 PropExpr->getSuperReceiverType() :
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006810 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6811
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00006812 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6813 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6814 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6815 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6816 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006817 }
6818 return false;
6819}
6820
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006821/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6822/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6823static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006824 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006825 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006826 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006827 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6828 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006829 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6830 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006831
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006832 unsigned Diag = 0;
6833 bool NeedType = false;
6834 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006835 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006836 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006837 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6838 NeedType = true;
6839 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006840 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006841 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6842 NeedType = true;
6843 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006844 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006845 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6846 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006847 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6848 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006849 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006850 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6851 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006852 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6853 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006854 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6855 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006856 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006857 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006858 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006859 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006860 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6861 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006862 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006863 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6864 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006865 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6866 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6867 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006868 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6869 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6870 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006871 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6872 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6873 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006874 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006875
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006876 SourceRange Assign;
6877 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6878 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006879 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006880 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006881 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006882 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006883 return true;
6884}
6885
6886
6887
6888// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006889QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6890 SourceLocation Loc,
6891 QualType CompoundType) {
6892 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6893 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006894 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006895
6896 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6897 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006898 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006899 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006900 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006901 // Simple assignment "x = y".
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00006902 if (LHS->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
6903 ConvertPropertyForLValue(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006904 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006905 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6906 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6907 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006908 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006909 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006910 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006911 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006912
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00006913 if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
6914 getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI &&
6915 LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
6916 Diag(Loc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6917 << LHSType;
6918
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006919 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6920 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6921 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006922 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006923 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6924 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6925 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006926 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6927 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006928 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006929 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006930 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6931 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6932 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006933 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6934 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006935 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006936 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006937 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006938 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006939 }
6940 } else {
6941 // Compound assignment "x += y"
John McCall1c23e912010-11-16 02:32:08 +00006942 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006943 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006944
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006945 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006946 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006947 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006948
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006949
6950 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6951 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6952 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6953 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6954 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6955 // check.
6956 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006957 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006958 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6959 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6960 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6961 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6962 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6963 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6964 }
6965
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006966 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6967 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006968 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006969 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6970 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006971 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006972 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006973 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6974 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006975}
6976
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006977// C99 6.5.17
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00006978static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00006979 SourceLocation Loc) {
6980 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006981
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00006982 ExprResult LHSResult = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006983 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6984 return QualType();
6985
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00006986 ExprResult RHSResult = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006987 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6988 return QualType();
6989 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6990
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006991 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6992 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6993 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006994
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00006995 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
6996 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
6997 S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS);
6998
6999 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007000 S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00007001 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007002 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00007003 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007004
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00007005 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007006}
7007
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00007008/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
7009/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007010static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
7011 ExprValueKind &VK,
7012 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7013 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007014 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007015 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007016
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007017 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
7018 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007019
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007020 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007021 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
7022 if (!isInc) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007023 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007024 return QualType();
7025 }
7026 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007027 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007028 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007029 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00007030 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
7031 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007032
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007033 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007034 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007035 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7036 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00007037 << Op->getSourceRange();
7038 return QualType();
7039 }
7040
7041 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007042 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007043 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007044 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7045 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00007046 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
7047 return QualType();
7048 }
7049
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007050 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007051 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007052 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
7053 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007054 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00007055 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00007056 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00007057 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007058 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && S.LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
7059 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00007060 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
7061 return QualType();
7062 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00007063 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007064 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007065 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007066 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007067 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007068 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007069 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007070 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.take(), VK, OpLoc,
7071 isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007072 } else {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007073 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00007074 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00007075 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007076 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007077 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00007078 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007079 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007080 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007081 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
7082 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
7083 // operand.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007084 if (isPrefix && S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7085 VK = VK_LValue;
7086 return ResType;
7087 } else {
7088 VK = VK_RValue;
7089 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
7090 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007091}
7092
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007093void Sema::ConvertPropertyForRValue(Expr *&E) {
7094 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_LValue &&
7095 E->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty);
7096 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = E->getObjCProperty();
7097
7098 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
7099 if (PRE->isImplicitProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian99130e52010-12-22 19:46:35 +00007100 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *GetterMethod =
7101 PRE->getImplicitPropertyGetter()) {
7102 QualType Result = GetterMethod->getResultType();
7103 VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Result);
7104 }
7105 else {
7106 Diag(PRE->getLocation(), diag::err_getter_not_found)
7107 << PRE->getBase()->getType();
7108 }
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007109 }
7110
7111 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E->getType(), CK_GetObjCProperty,
7112 E, 0, VK);
John McCalldb67e2f2010-12-10 01:49:45 +00007113
7114 ExprResult Result = MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
7115 if (!Result.isInvalid())
7116 E = Result.take();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007117}
7118
7119void Sema::ConvertPropertyForLValue(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType &LHSTy) {
7120 assert(LHS->getValueKind() == VK_LValue &&
7121 LHS->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty);
7122 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
7123
7124 if (PRE->isImplicitProperty()) {
7125 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
7126 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
7127 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
7128 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter()) {
7129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
7130 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
7131
7132 // Otherwise, if the getter returns an l-value, just call that.
7133 } else {
7134 QualType Result = PRE->getImplicitPropertyGetter()->getResultType();
7135 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Result);
7136 if (VK == VK_LValue) {
7137 LHS = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, LHS->getType(),
7138 CK_GetObjCProperty, LHS, 0, VK);
7139 return;
John McCall12f78a62010-12-02 01:19:52 +00007140 }
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007141 }
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007142 }
7143
7144 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007145 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007146 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007147 Expr *Arg = RHS;
7148 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
7149 Owned(Arg));
7150 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007151 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007152 }
7153}
7154
7155
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007156/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007157/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007158/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
7159/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
7160/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
7161/// - &(x) => x
7162/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
7163/// - &s.xx => s
7164/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
7165/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
7166/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
7167/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007168static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007169 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007170 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007171 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007172 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007173 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
7174 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
7175 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007176 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007177 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007178 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007179 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007180 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00007181 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
7182 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007183 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
7184 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
7185 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
7186 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
7187 }
7188 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00007189 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007190 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
7191 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007192
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007193 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007194 case UO_Real:
7195 case UO_Imag:
7196 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00007197 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
7198 default:
7199 return 0;
7200 }
7201 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007202 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007203 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007204 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007205 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
7206 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00007207 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007208 default:
7209 return 0;
7210 }
7211}
7212
7213/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007214/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007215/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007216/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007217/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007218/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007219/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007220static QualType CheckAddressOfOperand(Sema &S, Expr *OrigOp,
7221 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007222 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007223 return S.Context.DependentTy;
7224 if (OrigOp->getType() == S.Context.OverloadTy)
7225 return S.Context.OverloadTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007226
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007227 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007228 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
7229 OrigOp = PR.take();
7230
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007231 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
7232 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00007233
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007234 if (S.getLangOptions().C99) {
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00007235 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
7236 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007237 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00007238 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
7239 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
7240 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
7241 }
7242 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
7243 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
7244 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007245 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007246 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(S.Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00007247
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007248 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007249 bool sfinae = S.isSFINAEContext();
7250 S.Diag(OpLoc, sfinae ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
7251 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00007252 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007253 if (sfinae)
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00007254 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007255 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007256 return S.Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007257 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
7258 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
7259 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
7260
7261 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
7262 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007263 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007264 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7265 return QualType();
7266 }
7267 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
7268 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
7269
7270 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
7271 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007272 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007273 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
7274
7275 // The method was named without a qualifier.
7276 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007277 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007278 << op->getSourceRange();
7279 }
7280
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007281 return S.Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7282 S.Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007283 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007284 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007285 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007286 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00007287 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007288 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007289 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007290 return QualType();
7291 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007292 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007293 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007294 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007295 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00007296 return QualType();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007297 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00007298 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007299 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00007300 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00007301 return QualType();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00007302 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00007303 // cannot take address of a property expression.
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007304 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00007305 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
7306 return QualType();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00007307 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007308 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007309 // with the register storage-class specifier.
7310 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00007311 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
7312 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00007313 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007314 !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7315 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007316 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007317 return QualType();
7318 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007319 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007320 return S.Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007321 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00007322 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007323 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
7324 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00007325 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007326 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007327 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
7328 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007329 S.Diag(OpLoc,
7330 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007331 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
7332 return QualType();
7333 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007334
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007335 return S.Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
7336 S.Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00007337 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00007338 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00007339 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007340 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007341 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007342
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007343 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
7344 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
7345 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
7346 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007347 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00007348 }
7349
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007350 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00007351 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007352 return S.Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
7353 return S.Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007354}
7355
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007356/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007357static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
7358 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007359 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007360 return S.Context.DependentTy;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007361
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007362 S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007363 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
7364 QualType Result;
7365
7366 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
7367 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
7368 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
7369 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
7370 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7371 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
7372 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
7373 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7374 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007375 else {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007376 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007377 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007378 if (PR.take() != Op)
7379 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.take(), VK, OpLoc);
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007380 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007381
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007382 if (Result.isNull()) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007383 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007384 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
7385 return QualType();
7386 }
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007387
7388 // Dereferences are usually l-values...
7389 VK = VK_LValue;
7390
7391 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
7392 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7393 IsCForbiddenLValueType(S.Context, Result))
7394 VK = VK_RValue;
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00007395
7396 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007397}
7398
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007399static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007400 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007401 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007402 switch (Kind) {
7403 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007404 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
7405 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
7406 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
7407 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
7408 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
7409 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
7410 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
7411 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
7412 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
7413 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
7414 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
7415 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
7416 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
7417 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
7418 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
7419 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
7420 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
7421 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
7422 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
7423 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
7424 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
7425 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
7426 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
7427 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
7428 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
7429 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
7430 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
7431 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
7432 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
7433 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
7434 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
7435 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007436 }
7437 return Opc;
7438}
7439
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007440static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007441 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007442 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007443 switch (Kind) {
7444 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007445 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
7446 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
7447 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
7448 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
7449 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
7450 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
7451 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
7452 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
7453 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
7454 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
7455 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007456 }
7457 return Opc;
7458}
7459
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007460/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7461/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7462/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007463ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007464 unsigned Op,
7465 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007466 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007467 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007468 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
7469 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
7470 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007471 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
7472 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007473
7474 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007475 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007476 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007477 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7478 lhs->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007479 VK = lhs->getValueKind();
7480 OK = lhs->getObjectKind();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007481 }
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007482 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007483 case BO_PtrMemD:
7484 case BO_PtrMemI:
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007485 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, VK, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007486 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007487 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007488 case BO_Mul:
7489 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007490 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007491 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007492 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007493 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007494 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7495 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007496 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007497 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7498 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007499 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007500 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7501 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007502 case BO_Shl:
7503 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007504 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7505 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007506 case BO_LE:
7507 case BO_LT:
7508 case BO_GE:
7509 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007510 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007511 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007512 case BO_EQ:
7513 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007514 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007515 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007516 case BO_And:
7517 case BO_Xor:
7518 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007519 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7520 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007521 case BO_LAnd:
7522 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00007523 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007524 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007525 case BO_MulAssign:
7526 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007527 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007528 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007529 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7530 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7531 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007532 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007533 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007534 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7535 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7536 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7537 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007538 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007539 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007540 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7541 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7542 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007543 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007544 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007545 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7546 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7547 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007548 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007549 case BO_ShlAssign:
7550 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007551 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7552 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7553 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7554 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007555 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007556 case BO_AndAssign:
7557 case BO_XorAssign:
7558 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007559 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7560 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7561 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7562 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007563 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007564 case BO_Comma:
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007565 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007566 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7567 VK = rhs->getValueKind();
7568 OK = rhs->getObjectKind();
7569 }
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007570 break;
7571 }
7572 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007573 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007574 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007575 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
7576 VK, OK, OpLoc));
7577
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007578 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhs->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007579 VK = VK_LValue;
7580 OK = lhs->getObjectKind();
7581 }
7582 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
7583 VK, OK, CompLHSTy,
7584 CompResultTy, OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007585}
7586
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007587/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
7588/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007589static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
7590 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007591 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
7592 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
7593 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007594 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007595 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
7596
7597 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
7598 return;
7599
7600 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
7601 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7602 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007603 return;
7604 }
7605
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007606 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
7607 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007608 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007609
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007610 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007611 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007612
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007613 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
7614 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7615 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
7616 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007617 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007618 return;
7619 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007620
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007621 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007622 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
7623 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007624}
7625
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007626/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
7627/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
7628/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
7629/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007630static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007631 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007632 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
7633 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
7634 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
7635 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007636 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007637 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007638 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
7639
7640 // Subs are not binary operators.
7641 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
7642 return;
7643
7644 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
7645 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007646 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
7647 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007648 return;
7649
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007650 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007651 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007652 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007653 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
7654 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007655 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007656 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007657 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
7658 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7659 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
7660 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007661 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007662 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007663 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007664 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
7665 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007666 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007667 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007668 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
7669 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7670 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
7671 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007672}
7673
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007674/// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
7675/// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
7676/// in parentheses.
7677static void
7678EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7679 Expr *E) {
7680 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(E) &&
7681 cast<BinaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
7682 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
7683 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
7684 << E->getSourceRange(),
7685 Self.PDiag(diag::note_logical_and_in_logical_or_silence),
7686 E->getSourceRange(),
7687 Self.PDiag(0), SourceRange());
7688}
7689
7690/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7691/// 'true'.
7692static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7693 bool Res;
7694 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
7695}
7696
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007697/// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
7698/// 'false'.
7699static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
7700 bool Res;
7701 return E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
7702}
7703
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007704/// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
7705static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007706 Expr *OrLHS, Expr *OrRHS) {
7707 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrLHS)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007708 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007709 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7710 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, OrRHS))
7711 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007712 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7713 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
7714 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
7715 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
7716 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
7717 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
7718 // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
7719 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
7720 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
7721 }
7722 }
7723 }
7724}
7725
7726/// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
7727static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007728 Expr *OrLHS, Expr *OrRHS) {
7729 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrRHS)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007730 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007731 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7732 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, OrLHS))
7733 return;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007734 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
7735 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
7736 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007737 }
7738 }
7739}
7740
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007741/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007742/// precedence.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007743static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007744 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007745 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007746 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007747 return DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7748
Argyrios Kyrtzidis567bb712010-11-17 18:26:36 +00007749 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
7750 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd92ccaa2010-11-17 18:54:22 +00007751 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis47d512c2010-11-17 19:18:19 +00007752 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7753 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbee77f72010-11-16 21:00:12 +00007754 }
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007755}
7756
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007757// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007758ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007759 tok::TokenKind Kind,
7760 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
7761 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00007762 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
7763 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007764
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007765 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
7766 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
7767
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007768 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
7769}
7770
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007771ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007772 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
7773 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007774 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7775 bool UseBuiltinOperator;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007776
John McCall01b2e4e2010-12-06 05:26:58 +00007777 if (lhs->isTypeDependent() || rhs->isTypeDependent()) {
7778 UseBuiltinOperator = false;
7779 } else if (Opc == BO_Assign && lhs->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7780 UseBuiltinOperator = true;
7781 } else {
7782 UseBuiltinOperator = !lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
7783 !rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType();
7784 }
7785
7786 if (!UseBuiltinOperator) {
7787 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7788 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7789 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7790 // the arguments.
7791 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
7792 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
7793 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7794 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7795 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
7796 Functions);
7797
7798 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
7799 // binary operation.
7800 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
7801 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007802 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007804 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007805 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007806}
7807
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007808ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007809 unsigned OpcIn,
7810 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007811 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007812
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007813 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
7814 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007815 QualType resultType;
7816 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007817 case UO_PreInc:
7818 case UO_PreDec:
7819 case UO_PostInc:
7820 case UO_PostDec:
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007821 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input, VK, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007822 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7823 Opc == UO_PostInc,
7824 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7825 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007826 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007827 case UO_AddrOf:
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007828 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007829 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007830 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007831 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007832 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input, VK, OpLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007833 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007834 case UO_Plus:
7835 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007836 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7837 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007838 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7839 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00007840 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7841 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007842 break;
7843 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
7844 resultType->isEnumeralType())
7845 break;
7846 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007847 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007848 resultType->isPointerType())
7849 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007850 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7851 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7852 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7853 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7854 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007855
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007856 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7857 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007858 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007859 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7860 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007861 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7862 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007863 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7864 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7865 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007866 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007867 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007868 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7869 break;
7870 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7871 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7872 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7873 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7874 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007875 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7876 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007877 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007878 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007879 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007880 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007881 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007882 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007883 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7884 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007885 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7886 // ok, fallthrough
7887 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7888 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7889 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7890 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7891 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007892 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7893 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007894 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007895
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007896 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007897 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7898 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007899 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007900 case UO_Real:
7901 case UO_Imag:
John McCall09431682010-11-18 19:01:18 +00007902 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007903 // _Real and _Imag map ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values.
7904 if (Input->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
7905 Input->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
7906 VK = Input->getValueKind();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007907 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007908 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007909 resultType = Input->getType();
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007910 VK = Input->getValueKind();
7911 OK = Input->getObjectKind();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007912 break;
7913 }
7914 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007915 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007916
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007917 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType,
7918 VK, OK, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007919}
7920
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007921ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007922 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7923 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007924 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007925 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007926 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7927 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7928 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7929 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007930 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007931 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007932 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7933 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7934 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007935
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007936 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007937 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007938
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007939 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007940}
7941
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007942// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007943ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007944 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7945 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007946}
7947
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007948/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007949ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007950 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7951 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007952 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007953 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007954
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007955 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7956 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007957 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007958 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007959
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007960 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007961 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007962 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7963 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007964}
7965
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007966ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007967Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007968 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007969 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7970 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7971
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007972 bool isFileScope
7973 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007974 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007975 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007976
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007977 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7978 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7979 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007980
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007981 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7982 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7983 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007984 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007985 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7986 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007987 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007988 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007989 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7990 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007991 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007992 }
7993 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00007994 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
7995 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type.
7996 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastExpr);
7997 Ty = LastExpr->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7998
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007999 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
8000 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
8001 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
8002 Ty,
8003 false),
8004 SourceLocation(),
8005 Owned(LastExpr));
8006 if (Res.isInvalid())
8007 return ExprError();
8008 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
8009 if (!LastLabelStmt)
8010 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
8011 else
8012 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
8013 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
8014 }
8015 }
8016 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00008017 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008018
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008019 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
8020 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00008021 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
8022 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
8023 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
8024 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00008025}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00008026
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008027ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008028 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8029 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
8030 unsigned NumComponents,
8031 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008032 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008033 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00008034 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008035
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00008036 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
8037 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
8038 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008039 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008040 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
8041 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
8042
8043 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
8044 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
8045 if (!Dependent
8046 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
8047 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
8048 << TypeRange))
8049 return ExprError();
8050
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00008051 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
8052 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00008053 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
8054 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00008055 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00008056 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
8057 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008058
8059 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
8060 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
8061 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
8062 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
8063 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
8064 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
8065 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
8066 if (OC.isBrackets) {
8067 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
8068 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
8069 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
8070 if(!AT)
8071 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
8072 << CurrentType);
8073 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
8074 } else
8075 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
8076
8077 // The expression must be an integral expression.
8078 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
8079 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
8080 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
8081 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
8082 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
8083 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
8084 << Idx->getSourceRange());
8085
8086 // Record this array index.
8087 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
8088 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
8089 continue;
8090 }
8091
8092 // Offset of a field.
8093 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
8094 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
8095 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
8096 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
8097 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
8098 continue;
8099 }
8100
8101 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
8102 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
8103 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
8104 return ExprError();
8105
8106 // Look for the designated field.
8107 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
8108 if (!RC)
8109 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
8110 << CurrentType);
8111 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
8112
8113 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
8114 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
8115 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
8116 // (clause 9).
8117 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
8118 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
8119 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
8120 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
8121 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
8122 << CurrentType))
8123 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
8124 }
8125
8126 // Look for the field.
8127 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
8128 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
8129 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008130 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = 0;
8131 if (!MemberDecl) {
Benjamin Kramerd9811462010-11-21 14:11:41 +00008132 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008133 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
8134 }
8135
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008136 if (!MemberDecl)
8137 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
8138 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
8139 OC.LocEnd));
8140
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00008141 // C99 7.17p3:
8142 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
8143 //
8144 // We diagnose this as an error.
8145 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
8146 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
8147 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
8148 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
8149 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
8150 return ExprError();
8151 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008152
8153 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008154 if (IndirectMemberDecl)
8155 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008156
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00008157 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
8158 // the base class indirections.
8159 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
8160 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008161 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00008162 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
8163 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
8164 B != BEnd; ++B)
8165 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
8166 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00008167
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008168 if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
8169 for (IndirectFieldDecl::chain_iterator FI =
8170 IndirectMemberDecl->chain_begin(),
8171 FEnd = IndirectMemberDecl->chain_end(); FI != FEnd; FI++) {
8172 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(*FI));
8173 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
8174 cast<FieldDecl>(*FI), OC.LocEnd));
8175 }
8176 } else
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008177 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
Francois Pichet87c2e122010-11-21 06:08:52 +00008178
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008179 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
8180 }
8181
8182 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
8183 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
8184 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
8185}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008186
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008187ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008188 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
8189 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
8190 ParsedType argty,
8191 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
8192 unsigned NumComponents,
8193 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
8194
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00008195 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
8196 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
8197 if (ArgTy.isNull())
8198 return ExprError();
8199
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00008200 if (!ArgTInfo)
8201 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
8202
8203 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
8204 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00008205}
8206
8207
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008208ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008209 Expr *CondExpr,
8210 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
8211 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008212 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
8213
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008214 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
8215 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008216 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008217 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00008218 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008219 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008220 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008221 } else {
8222 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
8223 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
8224 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
8225 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008226 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
8227 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
8228 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008229
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008230 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008231 Expr *ActiveExpr = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
8232
8233 resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
8234 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
8235 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
8236 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00008237 }
8238
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008239 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008240 resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00008241 resType->isDependentType(),
8242 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00008243}
8244
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008245//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8246// Clang Extensions.
8247//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8248
8249/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008250void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008251 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
8252 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
8253 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00008254 if (BlockScope)
8255 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
8256 else
8257 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008258}
8259
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00008260void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00008261 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008262 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008263
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00008264 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008265 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00008266 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00008267
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008268 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008269 QualType RetTy;
8270 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008271 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008272 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008273 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008274 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
8275 } else {
8276 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008277 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008278 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008279
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008280 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008281
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008282 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
8283 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
8284 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00008285 return;
8286 }
8287
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008288 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
8289 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
8290 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8291 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
8292 return;
8293 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008294
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008295 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008296 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
8297 // ^ * { ... }
8298 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008299 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
8300 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008301
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008302 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008303 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
Abramo Bagnara723df242010-12-14 22:11:44 +00008304 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T.IgnoreParens())) {
8305 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL
8306 = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008307 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
8308 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00008309 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
8310 !Param->isImplicit() &&
8311 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
8312 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
8313 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008314 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00008315 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008316
8317 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
8318 // ^ fntype { ... }
8319 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
8320 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
8321 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8322 ParmVarDecl *Param =
8323 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
8324 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8325 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008326 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008327 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008328 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008329
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008330 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00008331 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008332 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00008333 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8334 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
8335 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
8336 }
8337
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008338 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00008339 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008340
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008341 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008342 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
8343 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
8344 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
8345 }
8346
8347 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
8348 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008349 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00008350 return;
8351
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008352 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008353 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
8354 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
8355
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008356 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008357 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis08274082010-12-15 18:44:22 +00008358 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008359
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008360 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00008361 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00008362 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008363}
8364
8365/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
8366/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
8367void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008368 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00008369 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008370 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008371}
8372
8373/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
8374/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008375ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008376 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00008377 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
8378 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
8379 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008380
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008381 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00008382
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00008383 PopDeclContext();
8384
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008385 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00008386 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
8387 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008388
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00008389 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008390 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008391
8392 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
8393 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
8394 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
8395
8396 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
8397 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
8398
8399 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
8400 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008401 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
8402 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
8403 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008404
8405 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
8406 // preserve its sugar structure.
8407 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
8408 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
8409 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
8410
8411 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
8412 } else {
8413 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008414 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8415 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently?
8416 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008417 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
8418 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
8419 FPT->getNumArgs(),
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008420 EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008421 }
8422
8423 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
8424 } else {
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008425 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
8426 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default);
8427 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, EPI);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008428 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008429
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00008430 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
8431 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008432 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008433
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00008434 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00008435 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008436 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008437
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008438 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008439
8440 bool Good = true;
8441 // Check goto/label use.
8442 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
8443 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8444 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
8445
8446 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
8447 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008448 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
8449 if (!L->isUsed())
8450 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008451 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00008452 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008453
8454 // Emit error.
8455 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
8456 Good = false;
8457 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008458 if (!Good) {
8459 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00008460 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008461 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008462
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008463 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
8464 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
8465
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008466 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00008467 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
8468 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00008469 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00008470
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008471 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00008472 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00008473}
8474
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008475ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00008476 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008477 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008478 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
8479 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008480 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008481}
8482
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008483ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008484 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8485 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008486 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008487
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008488 // Get the va_list type
8489 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008490 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
8491 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
8492 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
8493 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008494 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008495 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
8496 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
8497 } else {
8498 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
8499 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008500 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008501 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008502 return ExprError();
8503 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008504
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008505 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
8506 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008507 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
8508 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008509 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00008510 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008511
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008512 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008513 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008514
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008515 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8516 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008517}
8518
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008519ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008520 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
8521 // pointers on the target.
8522 QualType Ty;
8523 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
8524 Ty = Context.IntTy;
8525 else
8526 Ty = Context.LongTy;
8527
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008528 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008529}
8530
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008531static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008532 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008533 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
8534 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008535
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008536 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8537 if (!PT)
8538 return;
8539
8540 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
8541 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
8542 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
8543 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
8544 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
8545 return;
8546 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008547
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008548 // Strip off any parens and casts.
8549 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
8550 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
8551 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008552
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008553 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008554}
8555
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008556bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
8557 SourceLocation Loc,
8558 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008559 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8560 bool *Complained) {
8561 if (Complained)
8562 *Complained = false;
8563
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008564 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
8565 bool isInvalid = false;
8566 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008567 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008568
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008569 switch (ConvTy) {
8570 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
8571 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008572 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008573 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
8574 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008575 case IntToPointer:
8576 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
8577 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008578 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008579 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008580 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
8581 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00008582 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
8583 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
8584 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008585 case FunctionVoidPointer:
8586 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
8587 break;
8588 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008589 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
8590 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
8591 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
8592 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
8593 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
8594 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
8595 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
8596 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
8597 // C++ semantics.
8598 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
8599 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
8600 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008601 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
8602 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00008603 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00008604 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00008605 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008606 case IntToBlockPointer:
8607 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
8608 break;
8609 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00008610 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008611 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008612 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008613 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008614 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
8615 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
8616 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00008617 case IncompatibleVectors:
8618 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
8619 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008620 case Incompatible:
8621 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
8622 isInvalid = true;
8623 break;
8624 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008625
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008626 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
8627 switch (Action) {
8628 case AA_Assigning:
8629 case AA_Initializing:
8630 // The destination type comes first.
8631 FirstType = DstType;
8632 SecondType = SrcType;
8633 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008634
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008635 case AA_Returning:
8636 case AA_Passing:
8637 case AA_Converting:
8638 case AA_Sending:
8639 case AA_Casting:
8640 // The source type comes first.
8641 FirstType = SrcType;
8642 SecondType = DstType;
8643 break;
8644 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008645
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008646 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008647 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008648 if (Complained)
8649 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008650 return isInvalid;
8651}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008652
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00008653bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008654 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
8655 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
8656 if (Result)
8657 *Result = ICEResult;
8658 return false;
8659 }
8660
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008661 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
8662
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008663 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008664 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
8665 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
8666
8667 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
8668 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
8669 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
8670 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
8671 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
8672 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
8673 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008674
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008675 return true;
8676 }
8677
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008678 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
8679 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008680
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008681 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis08274082010-12-15 18:44:22 +00008682 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice, EvalResult.DiagLoc)
8683 != Diagnostic::Ignored)
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008684 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008685
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008686 if (Result)
8687 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
8688 return false;
8689}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008690
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008691void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008692Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008693 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
8694 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008695}
8696
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008697void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008698Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
8699 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
8700 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
8701 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008702
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008703 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
8704 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
8705 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
8706 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
8707 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008708 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008709 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
8710 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
8711 I != IEnd; ++I)
8712 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
8713 }
8714
8715 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
8716 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
8717 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
8718 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
8719 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
8720 I != IEnd; ++I)
8721 Diag(I->first, I->second);
8722 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008723 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008724
8725 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
8726 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
8727 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
8728 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008729 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008730 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
8731 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
8732 ExprTemporaries.end());
8733
8734 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
8735 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008736}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008737
8738/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
8739///
8740/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
8741/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
8742/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
8743/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
8744///
8745/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
8746///
8747/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
8748void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
8749 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008750
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008751 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008752 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008753
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00008754 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
8755 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
8756 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
8757 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008758 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008759 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00008760 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008761 return;
8762 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008763
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008764 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
8765 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008766
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008767 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
8768 // an instantiation.
8769 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
8770 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008771
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008772 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008773 case Unevaluated:
8774 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
8775 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008776
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008777 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
8778 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
8779 // "used"; handle this below.
8780 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008781
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008782 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8783 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
8784 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
8785 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008786 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008787 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008788
8789 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
8790 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
8791 // containing expression is used.
8792 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008793 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008794
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008795 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00008796 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008797 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00008798 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00008799 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
8800 return;
8801 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
8802 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008803 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00008804 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008805 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008806 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
8807 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008808
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008809 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008810 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008811 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008812 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008813 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
8814 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008815 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
8816 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
8817 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008818 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00008819 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008820 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
8821 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008822 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00008823 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008824 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00008825 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00008826 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008827 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
8828 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
8829 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
8830 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8831 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008832 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008833 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008834 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008835 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008836 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
8837 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8838 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008839 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008840 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008841 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
8842 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008843
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008844 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
8845 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8846 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8847 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8848 Loc));
8849 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008850 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008851 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008852 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8853 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8854 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008855 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008856 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8857 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008858
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008859 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008860
8861 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8862 if (CurContext != Function)
8863 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008864
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008865 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008866 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008867
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008868 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008869 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008870 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008871 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8872 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8873 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8874 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8875 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8876 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008877 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008878 }
8879 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008880
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008881 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008882
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008883 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008884 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008885 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008886}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008887
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008888namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008889 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008890 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008891 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008892 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8893 Sema &S;
8894 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008895
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008896 public:
8897 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008898
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008899 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008900
8901 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8902 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008903 };
8904}
8905
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008906bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8907 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008908 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8909 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8910 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008911
8912 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008913}
8914
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008915bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008916 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8917 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8918 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008919 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008920 }
8921
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008922 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008923}
8924
8925void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8926 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008927 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008928}
8929
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008930namespace {
8931 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8932 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8933 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8934 Sema &S;
8935
8936 public:
8937 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8938
8939 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8940
8941 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8942 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8943 }
8944
8945 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8946 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008947 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008948 }
8949
8950 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8951 if (E->getConstructor())
8952 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8953 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8954 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8955 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8956 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008957 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008958 }
8959
8960 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8961 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8962 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008963 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8964 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8965 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8966 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8967 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8968 }
8969
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008970 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008971 }
8972
8973 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8974 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008975 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008976 }
8977
8978 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8979 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8980 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008981
8982 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8983 Visit(E->getExpr());
8984 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008985 };
8986}
8987
8988/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8989/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8990void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8991 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8992}
8993
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008994/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8995/// of the program being compiled.
8996///
8997/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008998/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008999/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
9000/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
9001/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
9002/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009003/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009004/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009005///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009006/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
9007/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
9008/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
9009/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009010bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009011 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
9012 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
9013 case Unevaluated:
9014 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
9015 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009016
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009017 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00009018 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009019 Diag(Loc, PD);
9020 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009021
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00009022 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
9023 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
9024 break;
9025 }
9026
9027 return false;
9028}
9029
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009030bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
9031 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
9032 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
9033 return false;
9034
9035 PartialDiagnostic Note =
9036 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
9037 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
9038 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009039
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009040 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009041 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009042 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
9043 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009044 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00009045 << CE->getSourceRange(),
9046 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
9047 return true;
9048
9049 return false;
9050}
9051
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009052// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
9053// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
9054void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
9055 SourceLocation Loc;
9056
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00009057 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
9058
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009059 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
9060 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009061 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009062 return;
9063
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009064 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
9065 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
9066 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9067 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
9068
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00009069 // self = [<foo> init...]
9070 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
9071 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
9072 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
9073
9074 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
9075 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
9076 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
9077 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
9078 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00009079
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009080 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
9081 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
9082 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
9083 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
9084 return;
9085
9086 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
9087 } else {
9088 // Not an assignment.
9089 return;
9090 }
9091
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009092 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00009093 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00009094
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00009095 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00009096 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00009097 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00009098 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
9099 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
9100 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009101}
9102
9103bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
9104 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
9105
9106 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00009107 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
9108 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
9109 << E->getSourceRange();
9110
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00009111 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
9112 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4
9113
9114 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCallabc56c72010-12-04 06:09:13 +00009115
9116 QualType T = E->getType();
John McCallf6a16482010-12-04 03:47:34 +00009117 if (!T->isScalarType()) // C99 6.8.4.1p1
9118 return Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
9119 << T << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00009120 }
9121
9122 return false;
9123}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009124
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009125ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
9126 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00009127 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009128 return ExprError();
9129
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009130 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009131 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00009132
9133 return Owned(Sub);
9134}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00009135
9136/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
9137/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
9138ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
9139 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
9140 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
9141
9142 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
9143 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
9144 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
9145 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
9146 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
9147 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
9148 Specialization->getAccess());
9149 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
9150 if (!E) return ExprError();
9151 return Owned(E);
9152 }
9153
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00009154 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00009155 return ExprError();
9156 }
9157
9158 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
9159 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
9160
9161 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
9162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
9163 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
9164 return ExprError();
9165}